blob: 549fa8fc9ae45199cc34412e9013ea3ba94fc67c [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor661b4932010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregorbf3af052008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Douglas Gregor3fc749d2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000032#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000033#include <algorithm>
34
35namespace clang {
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +000036using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000037
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000038/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
39/// function.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000040static ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000041CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregor5b8968c2011-07-15 16:25:15 +000042 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
43 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000044 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000045 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
46 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
47 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
48 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000049 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
50 if (E.isInvalid())
51 return ExprError();
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000052 return E;
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000053}
54
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000055static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
56 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +000057 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +000058 bool CStyle,
59 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Sam Panzerd0125862012-08-16 02:38:47 +000060
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +000061static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
62 QualType &ToType,
63 bool InOverloadResolution,
64 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
65 bool CStyle);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000066static OverloadingResult
67IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
68 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
69 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
70 bool AllowExplicit);
71
72
73static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
74CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
75 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
76 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
77
78static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
79CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
80 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
81 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
82
83static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
84CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
85 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
86 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
87
88
89
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000090/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
91/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000093GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
94 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
95 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
96 ICC_Identity,
97 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
98 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
99 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000100 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000101 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
102 ICC_Promotion,
103 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000104 ICC_Promotion,
105 ICC_Conversion,
106 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000107 ICC_Conversion,
108 ICC_Conversion,
109 ICC_Conversion,
110 ICC_Conversion,
111 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000112 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000113 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000114 ICC_Conversion,
115 ICC_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000116 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000117 ICC_Conversion
118 };
119 return Category[(int)Kind];
120}
121
122/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
123/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
124ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
125 static const ImplicitConversionRank
126 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
127 ICR_Exact_Match,
128 ICR_Exact_Match,
129 ICR_Exact_Match,
130 ICR_Exact_Match,
131 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000132 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000133 ICR_Promotion,
134 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000135 ICR_Promotion,
136 ICR_Conversion,
137 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000138 ICR_Conversion,
139 ICR_Conversion,
140 ICR_Conversion,
141 ICR_Conversion,
142 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000143 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000144 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000145 ICR_Conversion,
146 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000147 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
148 ICR_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000149 ICR_Conversion,
150 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000151 };
152 return Rank[(int)Kind];
153}
154
155/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
156/// implicit conversion.
157const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopes2550d702009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000158 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000159 "No conversion",
160 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
161 "Array-to-pointer",
162 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000163 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000164 "Qualification",
165 "Integral promotion",
166 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000167 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000168 "Integral conversion",
169 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000170 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000171 "Floating-integral conversion",
172 "Pointer conversion",
173 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000174 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000175 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000176 "Derived-to-base conversion",
177 "Vector conversion",
178 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000179 "Complex-real conversion",
180 "Block Pointer conversion",
181 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000182 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000183 };
184 return Name[Kind];
185}
186
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000187/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
188/// sequence to the identity conversion.
189void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
190 First = ICK_Identity;
191 Second = ICK_Identity;
192 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000193 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000194 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000195 ReferenceBinding = false;
196 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000197 IsLvalueReference = true;
198 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
199 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000200 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000201 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000202 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000203}
204
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000205/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
206/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
207/// implicit conversions.
208ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
209 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
210 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
211 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
212 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
213 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
214 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
215 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
216 return Rank;
217}
218
219/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
220/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000221/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000222/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000223bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000224 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
225 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
226 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
227 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000228 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCallddb0ce72010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000229 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
230 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
231 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlssonc8df0b62010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000232 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000233 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
234 return true;
235
236 return false;
237}
238
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000239/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
240/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
241/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
242/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000243bool
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000244StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000246 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000247 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000248
249 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
250 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
251 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
252 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
253 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
254
Douglas Gregorf9af5242011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000255 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000256 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000257 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
258
259 return false;
260}
261
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000262/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
263/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
264static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
265 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
266 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
267 case CK_NoOp:
268 case CK_IntegralCast:
269 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
270 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
271 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
272 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
273 case CK_FloatingCast:
274 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
275 continue;
276
277 default:
278 return Converted;
279 }
280 }
281
282 return Converted;
283}
284
285/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
286/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
287///
288/// \param Ctx The AST context.
289/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
290/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
291/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000292/// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
293/// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000294NarrowingKind
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000295StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
296 const Expr *Converted,
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000297 APValue &ConstantValue,
298 QualType &ConstantType) const {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000299 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000300
301 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
302 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
303 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
304 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
305 switch (Second) {
306 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
307 //
308 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
309 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
310 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
311 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
312 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
313 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
314 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
315 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
316 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
317 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
318 if (Initializer &&
319 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
320 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
321 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
322 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
323 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
324 // And back.
325 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
326 bool ignored;
327 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
328 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
329 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
330 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
331 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000332 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000333 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
334 }
335 } else {
336 // Variables are always narrowings.
337 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
338 }
339 }
340 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
341
342 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
343 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
344 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
345 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
346 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
347 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
348 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
349 // FromType is larger than ToType.
350 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
351 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
352 // Constant!
353 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
354 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
355 // Convert the source value into the target type.
356 bool ignored;
357 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
358 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
359 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
360 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
361 // values that can be represented.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000362 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
363 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000364 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000365 }
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000366 } else {
367 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
368 }
369 }
370 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
371
372 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
373 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
374 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
375 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
376 // value when converted back to the original type.
377 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
378 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
379 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
380 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
381 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
382 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
383 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
384 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
385 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
386 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
387 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
388 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
389 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
390
391 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000392 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
393 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000394 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
395 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
396 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000397 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
398 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
399 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000400 }
401 bool Narrowing = false;
402 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000403 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
404 // narrowing.
405 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000406 Narrowing = true;
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000407 } else {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000408 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
409 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
410 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
411 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
412 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
413 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
414 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
415 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
416 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
417 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
418 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000419 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
420 Narrowing = true;
421 }
422 if (Narrowing) {
423 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
424 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
425 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000426 }
427 }
428 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
429 }
430
431 default:
432 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
433 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
434 }
435}
436
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000437/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
438/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
439void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000440 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000441 bool PrintedSomething = false;
442 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000443 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000444 PrintedSomething = true;
445 }
446
447 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
448 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000449 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000450 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000451 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000452
453 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000454 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000455 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000456 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000457 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000458 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000459 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000460 PrintedSomething = true;
461 }
462
463 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
464 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000465 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000466 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000467 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000468 PrintedSomething = true;
469 }
470
471 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000472 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000473 }
474}
475
476/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
477/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
478void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000479 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000480 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
481 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000482 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000483 }
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000484 if (ConversionFunction)
485 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
486 else
487 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000488 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000489 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000490 After.DebugPrint();
491 }
492}
493
494/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
495/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
496void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000497 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000498 switch (ConversionKind) {
499 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000500 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000501 Standard.DebugPrint();
502 break;
503 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000504 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000505 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
506 break;
507 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000508 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000509 break;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000510 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000511 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000512 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000513 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000514 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000515 break;
516 }
517
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000518 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000519}
520
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000521void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
522 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
523}
524
525void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
526 conversions().~ConversionSet();
527}
528
529void
530AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
531 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
532 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
533 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
534}
535
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000536namespace {
537 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
538 // template parameter and template argument information.
539 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
540 TemplateParameter Param;
541 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
542 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
543 };
544}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000545
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000546/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
547/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
548OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000549static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
550 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000551 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000552 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
553 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000554 Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000555 Result.Data = 0;
556 switch (TDK) {
557 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000558 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000559 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000560 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
561 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000562 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000563
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000564 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000565 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000566 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
567 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000568
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000569 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000570 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000571 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
572 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000573 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
574 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
575 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
576 Result.Data = Saved;
577 break;
578 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000579
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000580 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000581 Result.Data = Info.take();
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000582 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
583 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
584 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
585 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
586 Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
587 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000588 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000589
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000590 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000591 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000592 break;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000593 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000594
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000595 return Result;
596}
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000597
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000598void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
599 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
600 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000601 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000602 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
603 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000604 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
605 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000606 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000607 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000608
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000609 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000610 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregoraaa045d2010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000611 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000612 Data = 0;
613 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000614
615 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000616 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000617 Data = 0;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000618 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
619 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
620 HasDiagnostic = false;
621 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000622 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000623
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000624 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000625 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000626 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
627 break;
628 }
629}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000630
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000631PartialDiagnosticAt *
632OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
633 if (HasDiagnostic)
634 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
635 return 0;
636}
637
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000638TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000639OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
640 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
641 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000642 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000643 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000644 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
645 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000646 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000647 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000648
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000649 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000650 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000651 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000652
653 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000654 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000655 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000656
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000657 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000658 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000659 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
660 break;
661 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000662
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000663 return TemplateParameter();
664}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000665
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000666TemplateArgumentList *
667OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
668 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
669 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000670 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000671 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
672 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
673 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
674 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
675 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
676 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000677 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000678 return 0;
679
680 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
681 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000682
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000683 // Unhandled
684 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
685 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
686 break;
687 }
688
689 return 0;
690}
691
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000692const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
693 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
694 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000695 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000696 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
697 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000698 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
699 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000700 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000701 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000702 return 0;
703
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000704 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000705 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000706 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000707
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000708 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000709 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000710 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
711 break;
712 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000713
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000714 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000715}
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000716
717const TemplateArgument *
718OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
719 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
720 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000721 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000722 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
723 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000724 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
725 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000726 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000727 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000728 return 0;
729
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000730 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000731 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000732 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
733
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000734 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000735 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000736 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
737 break;
738 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000739
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000740 return 0;
741}
742
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000743void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000744 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
Benjamin Kramer9e2822b2012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000745 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
746 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000747 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
748 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
749 }
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000750}
751
752void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
753 destroyCandidates();
Benjamin Kramer314f5542012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000754 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000755 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000756 Functions.clear();
757}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000758
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000759namespace {
760 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
761 struct Entry {
762 Expr **Addr;
763 Expr *Saved;
764 };
765 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
766
767 public:
768 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
769 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
770 Entry entry = { &E, E };
771 Entries.push_back(entry);
772 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
773 }
774
775 void restore() {
776 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
777 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
778 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
779 }
780 };
781}
782
783/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
784/// preprocessing on the given expression.
785///
786/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
787/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
788///
789/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
790static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
791 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000792 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
793 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
794 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
795 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
796
797 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
798 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
799 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
800 unbridgedCasts) {
801 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
802 return false;
803 }
804
805 // Go ahead and check everything else.
806 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
807 if (result.isInvalid())
808 return true;
809
810 E = result.take();
811 return false;
812 }
813
814 // Nothing to do.
815 return false;
816}
817
818/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
819/// placeholders.
820static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, Expr **args,
821 unsigned numArgs,
822 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
823 for (unsigned i = 0; i != numArgs; ++i)
824 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, args[i], &unbridged))
825 return true;
826
827 return false;
828}
829
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000830// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000831// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
832// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
833// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
834// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000835// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
836// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
837// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000838//
839// Example: Given the following input:
840//
841// void f(int, float); // #1
842// void f(int, int); // #2
843// int f(int, int); // #3
844//
845// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000846// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000847//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000848// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
849// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
850// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
851// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000852//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000853// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
854// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
855// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
856// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000857// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
858// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000859//
860// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
861// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
862// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
863// into a function template's signature.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000864Sema::OverloadKind
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000865Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
866 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000867 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000868 I != E; ++I) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000869 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
870
871 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
872 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
873 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
874
875 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
876 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
877 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
878
879 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
880 }
881
882 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
883 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
884 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
885 // function templates hide function templates with different
886 // return types or template parameter lists.
887 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
888 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
889
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000890 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000891 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
892 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
893 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
894 continue;
895 }
896
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000897 Match = *I;
898 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000899 }
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000900 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000901 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
902 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
903 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
904 continue;
905 }
906
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000907 Match = *I;
908 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000909 }
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000910 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000911 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
912 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
913 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000914 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
915 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000916 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
917 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
918 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
919 // template instantiation.
920 } else {
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000921 // (C++ 13p1):
922 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
923 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000924 Match = *I;
925 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000926 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000927 }
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000928
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000929 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000930}
931
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000932bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
933 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall7b492022010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000934 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
935 // overloads.
936 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
937 return false;
938
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000939 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
940 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
941
942 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
943 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
944 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
945 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
946 return true;
947
948 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
949 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
950 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
951
952 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
953 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
954 // in the signature, they are overloads.
955
956 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
957 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
958 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
959 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
960 return false;
961
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +0000962 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
963 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000964
965 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
966 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
967 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
968 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
969 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
970 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000971 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000972 return true;
973
974 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
975 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
976 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
977 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
978 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
979 // signature.
980 //
981 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
982 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000983 //
984 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
985 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
986 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000987 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
988 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
989 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
990 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
991 return true;
992
993 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregor57c9f4f2011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000994 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000995 //
996 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
997 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
998 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
999 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1000 // can be overloaded.
1001 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1002 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
1003 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
1004 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
Douglas Gregor57c9f4f2011-01-26 17:47:49 +00001005 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() ||
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001006 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) {
1007 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
1008 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() &&
1009 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1010 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1011 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001012 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1013 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1014 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1015 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001016 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
1017 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
1018 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
1019 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1020 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001021
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001022 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001023 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001024
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001025 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1026 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001027}
1028
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00001029/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1030/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1031///
1032/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1033/// an available function, false otherwise.
1034bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1035 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
1036}
1037
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001038/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1039///
1040/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1041/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1042static ImplicitConversionSequence
1043TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1044 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1045 bool AllowExplicit,
1046 bool InOverloadResolution,
1047 bool CStyle,
1048 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1049 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1050
1051 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1052 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1053 // we can perform.
1054 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1055 return ICS;
1056 }
1057
1058 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1059 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
1060 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1061 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
1062 AllowExplicit);
1063
1064 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1065 ICS.setUserDefined();
1066 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1067 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1068 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1069 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1070 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1071 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1072 // called for those cases.
1073 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1074 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1075 QualType FromCanon
1076 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1077 QualType ToCanon
1078 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1079 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1080 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1081 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1082 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1083 ICS.setStandard();
1084 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1085 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1086 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1087 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1088 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1089 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1090 }
1091 }
1092
1093 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
1094 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
1095 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
1096 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
1097 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
1098 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
1099 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
1100 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
1101 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
1102 }
1103 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1104 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1105 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1106 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1107 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1108 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1109 if (Cand->Viable)
1110 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1111 } else {
1112 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1113 }
1114
1115 return ICS;
1116}
1117
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001118/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1119/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1120/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1121/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001122///
1123/// void f(float f);
1124/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1125///
1126/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1127/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1128/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1129/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1130//
1131/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1132/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1133/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1134/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1135/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001136///
1137/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1138/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001139/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1140/// permitted.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001141///
1142/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1143/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1144/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001145static ImplicitConversionSequence
1146TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1147 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001148 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001149 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001150 bool CStyle,
1151 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001152 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001153 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001154 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001155 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001156 return ICS;
1157 }
1158
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001159 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001160 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001161 return ICS;
1162 }
1163
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001164 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1165 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1166 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1167 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1168 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1169 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1170 // called for those cases.
1171 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1172 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001173 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1174 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001175 ICS.setStandard();
1176 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1177 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1178 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001179
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001180 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1181 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1182 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1183 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1184 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001185
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001186 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001187 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001188 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001189
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001190 return ICS;
1191 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001192
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001193 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1194 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1195 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001196}
1197
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001198ImplicitConversionSequence
1199Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1200 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1201 bool AllowExplicit,
1202 bool InOverloadResolution,
1203 bool CStyle,
1204 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1205 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1206 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1207 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1208 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001209}
1210
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001211/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001212/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001213/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1214/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1215/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001216ExprResult
1217Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001218 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001219 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001220 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001221}
1222
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001223ExprResult
1224Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001225 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001226 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001227 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1228 return ExprError();
1229
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001230 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1231 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001232 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001233 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001234
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001235 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1236 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1237 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001238 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001239 /*CStyle=*/false,
1240 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001241 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1242}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001243
1244/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001245/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001246bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1247 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001248 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1249 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001250
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001251 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1252 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1253 // - a pointer
1254 // - a member pointer
1255 // - a block pointer
1256 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1257 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1258 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1259 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1260 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1261 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1262 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1263 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1264 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1265 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1266 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1267 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1268 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1269 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1270 } else {
1271 return false;
1272 }
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001273
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001274 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1275 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1276 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1277 return false;
1278 }
1279
1280 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1281 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1282 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1283
1284 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1285 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1286 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1287
1288 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001289 return true;
1290}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001291
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001292/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1293/// vector conversion.
1294///
1295/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1296/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001297static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
1298 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001299 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1300 // conversion.
1301 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1302 return false;
1303
1304 // Identical types require no conversions.
1305 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1306 return false;
1307
1308 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1309 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1310 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1311 // identity conversion.
1312 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1313 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001314
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001315 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001316 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001317 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1318 return true;
1319 }
1320 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001321
1322 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1323 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1324 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1325 // same size
1326 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1327 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001328 (Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions &&
Chandler Carruthc45eb9c2010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001329 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001330 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1331 return true;
1332 }
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001333 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001334
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001335 return false;
1336}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001337
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001338static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1339 bool InOverloadResolution,
1340 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1341 bool CStyle);
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001342
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001343/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1344/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1345/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1346/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1347/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1348/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1349/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1350/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001351static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1352 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001353 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001354 bool CStyle,
1355 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001356 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001357
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001358 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001359 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001360 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001361 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001362 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001363 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001364
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001365 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001366 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001367 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001368 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001369 return false;
1370
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001371 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001372 }
1373
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001374 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1375 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1376 // (C++ 4p1).
1377
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001378 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001379 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1380 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001381 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001382 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001383 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1384 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1385 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001386
1387 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1388 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1389 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1390 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1391 QualType resultTy;
1392 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001393 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001394 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1395 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1396 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1397 return false;
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001398 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001399
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001400 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1401 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1402 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1403 // expression.
1404 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1405 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1406 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1407 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1408 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1409 == UO_AddrOf &&
1410 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1411 const Type *ClassType
1412 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1413 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruthfc5c8fc2011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001414 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1415 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1416 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001417 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1418 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1419 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001420
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001421 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001422 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1423 FromType,
1424 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001425 } else {
1426 return false;
1427 }
Anders Carlsson2bd62502010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001428 }
John McCall21480112011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001429 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1430 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1431 // be converted to a prvalue.
1432 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001433 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001434 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001435 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001436 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001437
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001438 // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1439 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1440 // of the type of the lvalue ...
1441 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1442 FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1443
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001444 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1445 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001446 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1447 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001448 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001449 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1450 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001451 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001452
1453 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1454 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1455 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001456 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001457
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001458 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001459 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001460 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001461
1462 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1463 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1464 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1465 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001466 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1467 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001468 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001469 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001470 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001471 }
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001472 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001473 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001474 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001475
1476 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1477 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1478 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001479 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001480 } else {
1481 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001482 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001483 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001484 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001485
1486 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1487 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1488 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1489 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001490 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1491 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001492 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001493 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001494 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001495 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1496 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001497 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001498 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001499 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001500 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001501 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001502 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001503 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001504 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001505 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001506 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001507 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001508 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1509 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001510 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1511 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1512 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1513 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1514 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1515 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1516 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1517 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1518 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001519 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001520 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001521 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001522 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001523 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001524 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001525 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001526 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1527 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001528 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1529 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001530 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1531 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1532 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001533 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001534 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1535 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1536 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001537 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001538 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001539 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001540 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001541 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001542 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001543 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001544 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001545 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1546 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1547 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1548 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001549 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1550 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001551 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001552 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001553 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001554 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001555 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001556 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001557 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001558 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001559 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001560 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1561 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001562 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001563 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001564 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001565 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001566 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001567 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001568 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1569 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001570 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1571 InOverloadResolution,
1572 SCS, CStyle)) {
1573 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1574 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001575 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1576 CStyle)) {
1577 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001578 // appropriately.
1579 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001580 } else {
1581 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001582 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001583 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001584 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001585
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001586 QualType CanonFrom;
1587 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001588 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001589 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1590 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1591 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001592 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001593 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001594 FromType = ToType;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001595 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1596 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001597 } else {
1598 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001599 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1600
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001601 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001602 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1603 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1604 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001605 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1606 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001607 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001608 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian62ac5d02010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001609 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001610 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr()
1611 || CanonFrom.getObjCLifetime() != CanonTo.getObjCLifetime())) {
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001612 FromType = ToType;
1613 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1614 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001615 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001616 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001617
1618 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1619 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001620 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001621 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001622
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001623 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001624}
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001625
1626static bool
1627IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1628 QualType &ToType,
1629 bool InOverloadResolution,
1630 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1631 bool CStyle) {
1632
1633 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1634 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1635 return false;
1636 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1637 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1638 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1639 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1640 itend = UD->field_end();
1641 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001642 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1643 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001644 ToType = it->getType();
1645 return true;
1646 }
1647 }
1648 return false;
1649}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001650
1651/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1652/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1653/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1654/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001655bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001656 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlf7be9442008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001657 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001658 if (!To) {
1659 return false;
1660 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001661
1662 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1663 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1664 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1665 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1666 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregoraa74a1e2010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001667 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1668 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001669 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1670 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1671 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1672 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001673 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001674 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001675 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001676 }
1677
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001678 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1679 }
1680
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001681 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001682 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1683 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1684 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1685 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1686 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001687 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001688 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001689 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001690 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1691 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001692 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001693 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1694 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1695 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1696 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1697 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1698 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001699 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1700 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1701 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1702 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1703 return false;
1704
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001705 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1706 // even if that's not the promoted type.
1707 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
1708 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1709 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
1710 IsIntegralPromotion(From, Underlying, ToType);
1711 }
1712
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001713 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001714 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00001715 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0))
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001716 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1717 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001718 }
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001719
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001720 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001721 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1722 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1723 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001724 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001725 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001726 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001727 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001728 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001729 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001730 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001731 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1732 // unsigned.
David Majnemer0ad92312011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001733 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001734 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001735
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001736 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1737 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001738 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1739 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001740 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1741 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001742 };
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001743 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001744 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1745 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001746 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001747 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1748 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1749 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1750 // promotion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001751 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001752 }
1753 }
1754 }
1755
1756 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1757 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1758 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1759 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1760 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1761 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1762 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001763 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1764 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001765 using llvm::APSInt;
1766 if (From)
1767 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001768 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001769 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001770 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1771 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1772 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001773
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001774 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1775 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1776 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1777 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1778 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001779
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001780 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1781 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1782 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1783 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1784 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001785
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001786 return false;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001787 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001788 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001789
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001790 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1791 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001792 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001793 return true;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001794 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001795
1796 return false;
1797}
1798
1799/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1800/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1801/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001802bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001803 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1804 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001805 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1806 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001807 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1808 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1809 return true;
1810
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001811 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1812 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1813 // double is promoted to long double [...].
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001814 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001815 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1816 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1817 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1818 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001819
1820 // Half can be promoted to float.
1821 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
1822 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1823 return true;
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001824 }
1825
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001826 return false;
1827}
1828
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001829/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1830///
1831/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1832/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001833/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001834bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001835 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001836 if (!FromComplex)
1837 return false;
1838
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001839 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001840 if (!ToComplex)
1841 return false;
1842
1843 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001844 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1845 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1846 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001847}
1848
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001849/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1850/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1851/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1852/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1853/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001854///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001855static QualType
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001856BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001857 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001858 ASTContext &Context,
1859 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001860 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1861 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1862 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001863
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001864 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1865 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregor143c7ac2010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001866 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001867
1868 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001869 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001870 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001871 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001872
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001873 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1874 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1875
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001876 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001877 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001878 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001879 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregoraf7bea52010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001880 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001881
1882 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1883 // already.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001884 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1885 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001886 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1887 }
1888
1889 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001890 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1891 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001892
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001893 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1894 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1895 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001896}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001897
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001898static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001899 bool InOverloadResolution,
1900 ASTContext &Context) {
1901 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1902 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1903 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001904 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001905 return !InOverloadResolution;
1906
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001907 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1908 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1909 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001910}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001911
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001912/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1913/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1914/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1915/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1916/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1917/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001918///
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001919/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1920/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1921/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1922/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1923/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1924/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001925/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1926/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1927/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001928bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson08972922009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001929 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001930 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001931 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001932 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001933 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1934 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001935 return true;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001936
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001937 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1938 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001939 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor27b09ac2008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001940 ConvertedType = ToType;
1941 return true;
1942 }
1943
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001944 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1945 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001946 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001947 ConvertedType = ToType;
1948 return true;
1949 }
1950 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1951 // pointer type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001952 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001953 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001954 ConvertedType = ToType;
1955 return true;
1956 }
1957
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001958 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1959 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001960 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001961 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001962 ConvertedType = ToType;
1963 return true;
1964 }
1965
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001966 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001967 if (!ToTypePtr)
1968 return false;
1969
1970 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001971 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001972 ConvertedType = ToType;
1973 return true;
1974 }
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001975
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001976 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001977 // , including objective-c pointers.
1978 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001979 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001980 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001981 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1982 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1983 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001984 ToType, Context);
1985 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001986 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001987 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001988 if (!FromTypePtr)
1989 return false;
1990
1991 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001992
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001993 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregor4e938f57b2010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001994 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1995 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1996 return false;
1997
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001998 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1999 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2000 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedman13578692010-08-05 02:49:48 +00002001 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2002 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002003 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002004 ToPointeeType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002005 ToType, Context,
2006 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002007 return true;
2008 }
2009
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002010 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002011 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002012 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2013 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2014 ToPointeeType,
2015 ToType, Context);
2016 return true;
2017 }
2018
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002019 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2020 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002021 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002022 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002023 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002024 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002025 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002026 return true;
2027 }
2028
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002029 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002030 //
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002031 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2032 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2033 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2034 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2035 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2036 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2037 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2038 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
2039 //
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002040 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2041 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002042 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002043 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregorbf1764c2010-02-22 17:06:41 +00002044 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002045 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002046 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002047 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002048 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002049 ToType, Context);
2050 return true;
2051 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002052
Fariborz Jahanian5da3c082011-04-14 20:33:36 +00002053 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2054 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2055 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2056 ToPointeeType,
2057 ToType, Context);
2058 return true;
2059 }
2060
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002061 return false;
2062}
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002063
2064/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2065static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2066 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2067
2068 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2069 if (TQs == Qs)
2070 return T;
2071
2072 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2073 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2074
2075 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2076}
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002077
2078/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2079/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2080/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002081bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002082 QualType& ConvertedType,
2083 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002084 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002085 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002086
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002087 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2088 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2089
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002090 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002091 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2092 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002093 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002094 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002095
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002096 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002097 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2098 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2099 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2100 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2101 return false;
2102
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002103 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002104 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002105 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002106 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002107 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002108 return true;
2109 }
2110 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002111 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002112 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002113 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002114 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002115 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002116 return true;
2117 }
2118 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2119 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2120 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002121 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2122 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002123 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002124 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2125 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2126 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002127 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002128 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2129 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002130 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002131 return true;
2132 }
2133
2134 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2135 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2136 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2137 // complain about it.
2138 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002139 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002140 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2141 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002142 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002143 return true;
2144 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002145 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002146 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002147 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002148 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002149 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002150 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002151 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002152 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002153 // to a block pointer type.
2154 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002155 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002156 return true;
2157 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002158 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002159 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002160 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002161 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002162 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002163 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002164 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002165 return true;
2166 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002167 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002168 return false;
2169
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002170 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002171 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002172 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002173 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2174 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002175 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2176 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002177 return false;
2178
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002179 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2180 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2181 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2182 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2183 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2184 // We always complain about this conversion.
2185 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002186 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002187 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002188 return true;
2189 }
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002190 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2191 // as in I* to id.
2192 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2193 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2194 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2195 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002196
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002197 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002198 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002199 return true;
2200 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002201
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002202 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002203 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2204 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2205 // complain about it).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002206 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002207 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002208 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002209 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002210 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2211 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2212 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2213 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2214 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2215 return false;
2216
2217 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2218 // function types are obviously different.
2219 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2220 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2221 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2222 return false;
2223
2224 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2225 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
2226 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
2227 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2228 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2229 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
2230 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2231 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2232 HasObjCConversion = true;
2233 } else {
2234 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2235 return false;
2236 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002237
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002238 // Check argument types.
2239 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2240 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2241 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2242 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2243 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2244 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2245 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2246 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2247 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2248 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2249 HasObjCConversion = true;
2250 } else {
2251 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2252 return false;
2253 }
2254 }
2255
2256 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2257 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2258 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002259 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002260 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2261 return true;
2262 }
2263 }
2264
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002265 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002266}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002267
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002268/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2269/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2270///
2271/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2272///
2273/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2274///
2275/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2276/// this conversion.
2277bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2278 QualType &ConvertedType) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002279 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002280 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2281 return false;
2282
2283 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2284 QualType ToPointee;
2285 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2286 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2287 else
2288 return false;
2289
2290 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2291 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2292 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002293 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002294 return false;
2295
2296 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2297 QualType FromPointee;
2298 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2299 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2300 else
2301 return false;
2302
2303 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2304 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2305 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2306 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2307 return false;
2308
2309 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2310 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2311 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2312 return false;
2313
2314 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2315 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2316 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2317 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2318
2319 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2320 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2321 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2322 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2323 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2324 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2325 IncompatibleObjC))
2326 return false;
2327
2328 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2329 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2330 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2331 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2332 return true;
2333}
2334
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002335bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2336 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2337 QualType ToPointeeType;
2338 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2339 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2340 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2341 else
2342 return false;
2343
2344 QualType FromPointeeType;
2345 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2346 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2347 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2348 else
2349 return false;
2350 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2351 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2352 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2353
2354 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2355 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2356 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2357 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2358
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002359 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2360 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002361
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002362 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002363 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002364
2365 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2366 // function types are obviously different.
2367 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2368 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2369 return false;
2370
2371 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2372 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2373 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2374 return false;
2375
2376 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian462dae52011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002377 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2378 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002379 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2380 } else {
2381 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2382 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002383 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002384 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2385 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2386
2387 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2388 // OK exact match.
2389 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2390 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2391 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2392 return false;
2393 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2394 }
2395 else
2396 return false;
2397 }
2398
2399 // Check argument types.
2400 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2401 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2402 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2403 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2404 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2405 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2406 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2407 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2408 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2409 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2410 return false;
2411 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2412 } else
2413 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2414 return false;
2415 }
Fariborz Jahanian78213e42011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002416 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2417 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2418 ToFunctionType))
2419 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianf9d95272011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002420
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002421 ConvertedType = ToType;
2422 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002423}
2424
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002425enum {
2426 ft_default,
2427 ft_different_class,
2428 ft_parameter_arity,
2429 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2430 ft_return_type,
2431 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2432};
2433
2434/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2435/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2436/// parameter types, and different return types.
2437void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2438 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002439 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2440 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2441 PDiag << ft_default;
2442 return;
2443 }
2444
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002445 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2446 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2447 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2448 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2449 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) {
2450 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2451 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2452 return;
2453 }
2454 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2455 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002456 }
2457
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002458 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2459 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2460 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2461 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2462
2463 // Remove references.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002464 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2465 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2466
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002467 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2468 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2469 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2470 PDiag << ft_default;
2471 return;
2472 }
2473
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002474 // No extra info for same types.
2475 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2476 PDiag << ft_default;
2477 return;
2478 }
2479
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002480 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2481 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2482
2483 // Both types need to be function types.
2484 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2485 PDiag << ft_default;
2486 return;
2487 }
2488
2489 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) {
2490 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs()
2491 << FromFunction->getNumArgs();
2492 return;
2493 }
2494
2495 // Handle different parameter types.
2496 unsigned ArgPos;
2497 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2498 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2499 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos)
2500 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos);
2501 return;
2502 }
2503
2504 // Handle different return type.
2505 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(),
2506 ToFunction->getResultType())) {
2507 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType()
2508 << FromFunction->getResultType();
2509 return;
2510 }
2511
2512 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2513 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2514 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2515 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2516 return;
2517 }
2518
2519 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2520 PDiag << ft_default;
2521}
2522
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002523/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002524/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002525/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
2526/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
Sylvestre Ledrubed28ac2012-07-23 08:59:39 +00002527/// If the parameters are different, ArgPos will have the parameter index
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002528/// of the first different parameter.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002529bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002530 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2531 unsigned *ArgPos) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002532 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002533 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2534 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2535 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2536 if (!Context.hasSameType(*O, *N)) {
2537 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
2538 return false;
2539 }
2540 }
2541 return true;
2542 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002543
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002544 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2545 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2546 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2547 QualType ToType = (*O);
2548 QualType FromType = (*N);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002549 if (!Context.hasSameType(ToType, FromType)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002550 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2551 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth0ee93de2010-05-06 00:15:06 +00002552 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
2553 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
2554 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
2555 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002556 continue;
2557 }
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002558 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
2559 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002560 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002561 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002562 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2563 PTTo->getObjectType()->getBaseType(),
2564 PTFr->getObjectType()->getBaseType()))
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002565 continue;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002566 }
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002567 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002568 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002569 }
2570 }
2571 return true;
2572}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002573
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002574/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2575/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002576/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002577/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2578/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2579/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002580bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002581 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002582 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002583 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002584 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb3358722010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002585 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002586
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002587 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2588
David Blaikie50800fc2012-08-08 17:33:31 +00002589 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2590 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2591 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2592 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2593 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2594 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2595 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2596 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2597 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2598 << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2599 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002600 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2601 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002602 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2603 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregordda78892008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002604
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002605 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2606 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002607 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2608 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002609 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2610 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002611 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002612 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002613 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002614
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002615 // The conversion was successful.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002616 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002617 }
2618 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002619 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2620 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2621 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2622 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002623 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2624 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2625 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002626 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002627 return false;
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002628 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2629 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2630 } else {
2631 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002632 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002633 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2634 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2635 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002636 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002637
2638 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2639 // reasons.
2640 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2641 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2642
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002643 return false;
2644}
2645
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002646/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2647/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2648/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2649/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2650/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2651bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002652 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002653 bool InOverloadResolution,
2654 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002655 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002656 if (!ToTypePtr)
2657 return false;
2658
2659 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002660 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2661 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2662 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002663 ConvertedType = ToType;
2664 return true;
2665 }
2666
2667 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002668 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002669 if (!FromTypePtr)
2670 return false;
2671
2672 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2673 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2674 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2675 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002676
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002677 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002678 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002679 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002680 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2681 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2682 return true;
2683 }
2684
2685 return false;
2686}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002687
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002688/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2689/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002690/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002691/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2692/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2693/// otherwise.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002694bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002695 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002696 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002697 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002698 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002699 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002700 if (!FromPtrType) {
2701 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002702 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002703 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002704 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002705 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002706 return false;
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002707 }
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002708
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002709 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002710 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2711 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002712
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002713 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2714 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002715
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002716 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2717 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2718 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002719
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002720 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002721 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002722 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2723 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2724 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2725 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002726
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002727 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2728 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002729 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2730 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2731 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2732 return true;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002733 }
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002734
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002735 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002736 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2737 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2738 << From->getSourceRange();
2739 return true;
2740 }
2741
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002742 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall58e6f342010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002743 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2744 Paths.front(),
2745 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002746
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002747 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002748 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002749 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002750 return false;
2751}
2752
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002753/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2754/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2755/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002756///
2757/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2758/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2759/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002760bool
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002761Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002762 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002763 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2764 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002765 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2766
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002767 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2768 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redl22c92402010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002769 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002770 return false;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002771
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002772 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2773 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2774 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2775 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002776 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002777 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002778 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2779 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2780 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002781 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002782 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2783 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002784 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002785
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002786 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2787 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2788
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002789 // Objective-C ARC:
2790 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2791 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2792 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2793 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2794 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2795 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2796 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2797 } else {
2798 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2799 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2800 return false;
2801 }
2802 }
2803
Douglas Gregor377e1bd2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002804 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2805 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2806 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2807 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2808 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2809 }
2810
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002811 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2812 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002813 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002814 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002815
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002816 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2817 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002818 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002819 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002820 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002821
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002822 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2823 // include const.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002824 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002825 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002826 }
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002827
2828 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2829 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2830 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2831 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2832 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002833 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002834}
2835
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002836/// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
2837/// atomic type.
2838///
2839/// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
2840/// sequence to finish the conversion.
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00002841static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2842 bool InOverloadResolution,
2843 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2844 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002845 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
2846 if (!ToAtomic)
2847 return false;
2848
2849 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
2850 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
2851 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
2852 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
2853 return false;
2854
2855 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
2856 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
2857 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
2858 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2859 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
2860 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
2861 return true;
2862}
2863
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002864static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
2865 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
2866 QualType Type) {
2867 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
2868 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2869 if (CtorType->getNumArgs() > 0) {
2870 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getArgType(0);
2871 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
2872 return true;
2873 }
2874 return false;
2875}
2876
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002877static OverloadingResult
2878IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2879 CXXRecordDecl *To,
2880 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2881 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2882 bool AllowExplicit) {
2883 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
2884 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2885 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2886 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2887 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2888
2889 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2890 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2891 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2892 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2893 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2894 Constructor
2895 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2896 else
2897 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2898
2899 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2900 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2901 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2902 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002903 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
2904 // suppress conversions.
2905 bool SuppressUserConversions =
2906 isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002907 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2908 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2909 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002910 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002911 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002912 else
2913 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002914 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002915 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002916 }
2917 }
2918
2919 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2920
2921 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2922 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2923 case OR_Success: {
2924 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2925 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002926 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2927 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2928 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2929 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2930 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2931 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2932 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2933 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2934 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2935 return OR_Success;
2936 }
2937
2938 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2939 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2940 case OR_Deleted:
2941 return OR_Deleted;
2942 case OR_Ambiguous:
2943 return OR_Ambiguous;
2944 }
2945
2946 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
2947}
2948
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002949/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2950/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2951/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2952/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2953/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2954/// false and User is unspecified.
2955///
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002956/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2957/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2958/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002959static OverloadingResult
2960IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002961 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2962 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002963 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002964 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2965 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2966
2967 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2968 // constructors.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002969 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002970 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2971 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2972 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2973 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2974 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2975 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2976 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2977 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002978 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002979 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002980 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002981 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2982
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002983 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidise36bca62011-04-22 17:45:37 +00002984 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
2985 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
2986 // to try to recover.
2987 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor393896f2009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002988 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2989 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2990 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002991
2992 Expr **Args = &From;
2993 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
2994 bool ListInitializing = false;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00002995 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002996 // But first, see if there is an init-list-contructor that will work.
2997 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
2998 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
2999 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3000 return Result;
3001 // Never mind.
3002 CandidateSet.clear();
3003
3004 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3005 // arguments, not the entire list.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003006 Args = InitList->getInits();
3007 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3008 ListInitializing = true;
3009 }
3010
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003011 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003012 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003013 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003014 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
3015 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
3016
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003017 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
3018 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
3019 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003020 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003021 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003022 Constructor
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003023 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
3024 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003025 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003026
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003027 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3028 if (ListInitializing)
3029 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
3030 else
3031 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3032 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003033 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3034 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3035 SuppressUserConversions = false;
3036 if (NumArgs == 1) {
3037 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3038 // suppress conversions.
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00003039 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3040 S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003041 }
3042 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003043 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003044 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
3045 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003046 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003047 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003048 else
Fariborz Jahanian249cead2009-10-01 20:39:51 +00003049 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3050 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003051 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003052 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003053 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003054 }
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003055 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003056 }
3057 }
3058
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003059 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003060 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003061 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) {
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00003062 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003063 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003064 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003065 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003066 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3067 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +00003068 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianb191e2d2009-09-14 20:41:01 +00003069 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +00003070 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00003071 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003072 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3073 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003074 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3075 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3076 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3077
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003078 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3079 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003080 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3081 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003082 else
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003083 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003084
3085 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3086 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003087 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3088 ActingContext, From, ToType,
3089 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003090 else
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003091 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3092 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003093 }
3094 }
3095 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003096 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003097
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003098 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3099
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003100 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003101 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003102 case OR_Success:
3103 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3104 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3105 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3106 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3107 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3108 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3109 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3110 // the argument of the constructor.
3111 //
3112 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003113 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3114 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3115 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3116 } else {
3117 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3118 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3119 else {
3120 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3121 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3122 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003123 }
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003124 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003125 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003126 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003127 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3128 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3129 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3130 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003131 }
3132 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003133 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3134 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3135 //
3136 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3137 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3138 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3139 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3140 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003141 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003142 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003143 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003144 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003145
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003146 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3147 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3148 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3149 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3150 // is an initialization, the special rules for
3151 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3152 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3153 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3154 // 13.3.3.1).
3155 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3156 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003157 }
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003158 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003159
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003160 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3161 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3162 case OR_Deleted:
3163 // No conversion here! We're done.
3164 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003165
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003166 case OR_Ambiguous:
3167 return OR_Ambiguous;
3168 }
3169
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003170 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003171}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003172
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003173bool
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003174Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003175 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003176 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003177 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003178 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003179 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003180 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003181 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003182 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3183 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3184 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003185 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003186 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3187 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3188 else
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003189 return false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003190 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003191 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003192}
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003193
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003194/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3195/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3196/// is possible.
3197static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3198compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S,
3199 FunctionDecl *Function1,
3200 FunctionDecl *Function2) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003201 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus0x)
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003202 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3203
3204 // Objective-C++:
3205 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3206 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3207 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3208 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3209 // to keep code working.
3210 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3211 if (!Conv1)
3212 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3213
3214 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3215 if (!Conv2)
3216 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3217
3218 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3219 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3220 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3221 if (Block1 != Block2)
3222 return Block1? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3223 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3224 }
3225
3226 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3227}
3228
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003229/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3230/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3231/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003232static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3233CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3234 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3235 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003236{
3237 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3238 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3239 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3240 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3241 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3242 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3243 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3244 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003245 //
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003246 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3247 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3248 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3249 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3250 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003251 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3252 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003253 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003254 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003255
Benjamin Kramerb6eee072010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003256 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3257 // the same kind.
3258 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3259 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3260
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003261 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3262 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3263
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003264 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3265 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3266 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003267 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003268 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3269 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003270 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003271 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3272 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3273 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3274 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3275 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3276 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003277 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003278 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003279 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3280 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3281 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003282 else
3283 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3284 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3285 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003286 }
3287
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003288 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3289 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3290 // for some X and L2 does not.
3291 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003292 !ICS1.isBad() &&
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003293 ICS1.isListInitializationSequence() &&
3294 ICS2.isListInitializationSequence()) {
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003295 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3296 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3297 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3298 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3299 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3300 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003301 }
3302
3303 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003304}
3305
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003306static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3307 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3308 Qualifiers Quals;
3309 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003310 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003311 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003312
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003313 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3314}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003315
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003316// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3317// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3318static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3319compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3320 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3321 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3322 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3323 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3324
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003325 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregorae65f4b2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003326 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor4ae5b722011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003327 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3328 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3329 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3330 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003331
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003332 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3333 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3334 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3335 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3336 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3337 else
3338 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003339 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003340 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3341
3342 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3343 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3344 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3345 }
3346
3347 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3348 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3349 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3350 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3351
3352 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3353 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3354 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3355 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003356
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003357 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3358}
3359
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003360/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3361/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3362static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3363 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3364 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3365 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3366 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003367 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003368 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003369 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003370 // reference*.
3371 //
3372 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3373 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3374 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3375 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3376 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003377 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3378 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3379 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003380
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003381 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3382 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3383 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3384 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
3385}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003386
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003387/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3388/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3389/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003390static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3391CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3392 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3393 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003394{
3395 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3396 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3397
3398 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3399 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3400 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3401 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3402 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003403 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003404 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003405 return CK;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003406
3407 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3408 // defined below), or, if not that,
3409 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3410 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3411 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3412 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3413 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3414 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003415
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003416 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3417 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3418 // applies:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003419
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003420 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3421 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3422 // that is such a conversion.
3423 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3424 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3425 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3426 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3427
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003428 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3429 //
3430 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003431 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3432 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3433 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003434 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003435 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003436 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003437 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003438 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3439 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3440 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003441 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3442 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003443 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3444 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3445 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003446 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003447 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003448 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003449 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3450 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003451 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3452 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3453 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003454 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3455 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003456
3457 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3458 // conversion, if we need to.
3459 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003460 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003461 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003462 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003463
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003464 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3465 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003466
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003467 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003468 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003469 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003470 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3471
3472 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3473 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003474 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3475 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3476 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3477 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3478 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3479 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3480 FromObjCPtr2);
3481 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3482 FromObjCPtr1);
3483 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3484 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3485 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3486 }
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003487 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003488 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003489
3490 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3491 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003492 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003493 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003494 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003495
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003496 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003497 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3498 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3499 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3500 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3501 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003502
Sebastian Redlf2e21e52009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003503 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3504 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3505 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3506 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3507 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3508 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003509 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3510 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003511 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3512 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003513 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003514 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3515 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003516 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003517 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3518 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3519 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3520 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3521 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3522 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3523 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3524 }
3525
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003526 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3527 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003528 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003529 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003530 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003531 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003532 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3533 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3534 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003535 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003536 }
3537 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003538
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003539 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3540 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3541 // is between types of the same size.
3542 // For example:
3543 // void f(float);
3544 // void f(int);
3545 // int main {
3546 // long a;
3547 // f(a);
3548 // }
3549 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3550 // as clang will do in standard mode.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003551 if (S.getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode &&
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003552 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3553 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3554 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3555 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3556 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3557
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003558 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3559}
3560
3561/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3562/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003563/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3564ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003565CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3566 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3567 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregorba7e2102008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003568 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003569 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3570 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3571 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3572 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3573 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3574 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3575 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3576 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3577
3578 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3579 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003580 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3581 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003582 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3583 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003584 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003585 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3586 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003587
3588 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3589 // them.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003590 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003591 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3592
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003593 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3594 // for comparison.
3595 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003596 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003597 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003598 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003599
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003600 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003601 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003602
3603 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3604 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3605 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3606 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3607 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3608 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3609 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3610 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3611 }
3612
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003613 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003614 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3615 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3616 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003617 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003618 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3619 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3620 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3621 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3622 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3623 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3624 // about how the sequences rank.
3625 ;
3626 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3627 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3628 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3629 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3630 // qualifiers.
3631 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003632
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003633 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3634 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3635 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3636 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3637 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3638 // qualifiers.
3639 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003640
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003641 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3642 } else {
3643 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3644 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3645 }
3646
3647 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003648 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003649 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003650 }
3651
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003652 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3653 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3654 switch (Result) {
3655 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003656 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003657 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3658 break;
3659
3660 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3661 break;
3662
3663 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003664 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003665 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3666 break;
3667 }
3668
3669 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003670}
3671
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003672/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3673/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003674/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3675/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3676/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003677ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003678CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3679 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3680 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003681 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003682 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003683 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003684 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003685
3686 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3687 // conversion, if we need to.
3688 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003689 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003690 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003691 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003692
3693 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003694 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3695 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3696 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3697 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003698
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003699 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003700 //
3701 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3702 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003703 //
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003704 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003705 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003706 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3707 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3708 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3709 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003710 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003711 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003712 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003713 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003714 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003715 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003716 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003717 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003718
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003719 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003720 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003721 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003722 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003723 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003724 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3725 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003726
3727 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3728 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003729 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003730 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003731 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003732 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003733 }
3734 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3735 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3736 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3737 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3738 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3739 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3740 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3741 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3742 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3743 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3744
3745 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3746 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3747 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3748 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3749 // Objective-C pointer types.
3750 bool FromAssignLeft
3751 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3752 bool FromAssignRight
3753 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3754 bool ToAssignLeft
3755 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3756 bool ToAssignRight
3757 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3758
3759 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3760 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3761 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3762 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3763 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3764 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3765 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3766 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3767
3768 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3769 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3770 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3771 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3772 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3773 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3774
3775 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3776 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3777 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3778 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3779 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3780 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3781 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3782 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3783
3784 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3785 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3786 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3787 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3788 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3789 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003790
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003791 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3792 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3793 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3794 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3795 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3796 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3797
3798 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3799 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3800 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3801 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3802 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003803 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003804 }
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003805
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003806 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003807 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3808 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3809 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003810 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003811 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003812 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003813 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003814 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003815 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003816 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003817 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3818 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3819 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3820 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3821 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3822 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3823 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3824 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3825 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003826 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003827 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003828 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003829 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003830 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003831 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3832 }
3833 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3834 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003835 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003836 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003837 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003838 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3839 }
3840 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003841
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003842 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003843 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003844 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3845 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3846 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003847 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3848 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3849 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003850 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003851 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003852 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3853 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003854
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003855 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003856 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3857 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3858 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003859 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3860 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3861 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003862 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003863 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003864 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3865 }
3866 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003867
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003868 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3869}
3870
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003871/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3872/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3873/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3874/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3875/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3876/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3877/// type being initialized.
3878Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3879Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3880 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003881 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003882 bool &ObjCConversion,
3883 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003884 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3885 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3886 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3887
3888 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3889 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3890 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3891 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3892 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3893
3894 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3895 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3896 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3897 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003898 DerivedToBase = false;
3899 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003900 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003901 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3902 // Nothing to do.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003903 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003904 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3905 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003906 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3907 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3908 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3909 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003910 else
3911 return Ref_Incompatible;
3912
3913 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3914 // least).
3915
3916 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3917 // for comparison.
3918 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3919 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3920 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3921 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3922
3923 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3924 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3925 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3926 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3927 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3928 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3929 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003930 //
3931 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3932 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3933 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3934 // space 2.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003935 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
3936 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
3937 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3938 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3939 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3940 }
3941
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003942 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003943 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003944 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003945 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
3946 else
3947 return Ref_Related;
3948}
3949
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003950/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003951/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
3952static bool
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003953FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
3954 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3955 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
3956 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003957 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
3958 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
3959 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3960
3961 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
3962 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3963 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3964 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3965 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
3966 NamedDecl *D = *I;
3967 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3968 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3969 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3970
3971 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
3972 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3973 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3974 if (ConvTemplate)
3975 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3976 else
3977 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3978
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003979 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003980 // explicit conversions, skip it.
3981 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
3982 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003983
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003984 if (AllowRvalues) {
3985 bool DerivedToBase = false;
3986 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003987 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00003988
3989 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
3990 // functions that return lvalues.
3991 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
3992 const ReferenceType *RefType
3993 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
3994 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
3995 continue;
3996 }
3997
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003998 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003999 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4000 DeclLoc,
4001 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4002 .getUnqualifiedType(),
4003 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004004 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004005 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004006 continue;
4007 } else {
4008 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4009 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4010 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4011
4012 const ReferenceType *RefType =
4013 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4014 if (!RefType ||
4015 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4016 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4017 continue;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004018 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004019
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004020 if (ConvTemplate)
4021 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004022 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004023 else
4024 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004025 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004026 }
4027
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004028 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4029
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004030 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00004031 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004032 case OR_Success:
4033 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4034 //
4035 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4036 // applying a conversion function to the argument
4037 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4038 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4039 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4040 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4041 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4042 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4043 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4044 return false;
4045
4046 ICS.setUserDefined();
4047 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4048 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004049 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004050 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00004051 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004052 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4053 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4054 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4055 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4056 return true;
4057
4058 case OR_Ambiguous:
4059 ICS.setAmbiguous();
4060 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4061 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4062 if (Cand->Viable)
4063 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
4064 return true;
4065
4066 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4067 case OR_Deleted:
4068 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4069 // conversion; continue with other checks.
4070 return false;
4071 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004072
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004073 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004074}
4075
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004076/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4077/// initialization.
4078static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004079TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004080 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4081 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00004082 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004083 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4084
4085 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4086 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4087 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4088
4089 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4090 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4091
4092 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4093 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4094 // type of the resulting function.
4095 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4096 DeclAccessPair Found;
4097 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4098 false, Found))
4099 T2 = Fn->getType();
4100 }
4101
4102 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4103 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4104 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004105 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004106 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004107 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004108 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004109 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004110 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004111
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004112
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004113 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004114 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4115 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4116
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004117 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004118 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004119 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4120 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4121 //
4122 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4123 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4124 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004125 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004126 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4127 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4128 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4129 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4130 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4131 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4132 ICS.setStandard();
4133 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004134 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4135 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4136 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004137 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4138 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4139 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4140 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4141 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4142 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4143 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004144 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4145 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4146 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004147 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004148 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004149 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004150
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004151 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4152 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4153 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4154 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004155 return ICS;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004156 }
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004157
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004158 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4159 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4160 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4161 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4162 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4163 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4164 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4165 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004166 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004167 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004168 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4169 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4170 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004171 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004172 }
4173 }
4174
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004175 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4176 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004177 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004178 //
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004179 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4180 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4181 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4182 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4183 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4184 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4185 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004186 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4187 // go together.
Richard Smith8ab10aa2012-05-24 04:29:20 +00004188 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004189 return ICS;
4190
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004191 // -- If the initializer expression
4192 //
4193 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004194 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004195 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4196 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4197 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4198 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4199 ICS.setStandard();
4200 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004201 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004202 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4203 : ICK_Identity;
4204 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4205 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4206 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4207 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4208 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4209 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4210 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4211 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4212 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4213 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4214 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004215 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004216 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus0x ||
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004217 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004218 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4219 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004220 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004221 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004222 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004223 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004224 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004225 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004226
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004227 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4228 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004229 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4230 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004231 // "cv3 T3",
4232 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004233 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004234 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004235 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004236 // class subobject).
4237 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004238 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004239 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4240 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4241 AllowExplicit)) {
4242 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4243 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4244 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4245 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004246 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004247 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4248 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4249
Douglas Gregor68ed68b2011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004250 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolaaa5952c2011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004251 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004252
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004253 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4254 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4255 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4256 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4257 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4258 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4259 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4260 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4261 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4262 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4263 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4264 // initialization fails.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004265 //
4266 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4267 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4268 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4269 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4270 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4271 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4272 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4273 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4274 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4275 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004276 }
4277
4278 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4279 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4280 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4281 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4282 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4283 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4284 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4285 return ICS;
4286
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004287 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4288 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4289 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4290 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4291 return ICS;
4292
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004293 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004294 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4295 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4296 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4297 // underlying type of the reference according to
4298 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4299 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4300 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4301 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4302 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004303 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4304 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004305 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004306 /*CStyle=*/false,
4307 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004308
4309 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4310 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4311 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004312 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4313 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4314 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004315 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004316 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004317 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004318 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues.
4319 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4320 if (const ReferenceType *RefType
4321 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType()
4322 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
4323 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) {
4324 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init,
4325 DeclType);
4326 return ICS;
4327 }
4328 }
4329 }
4330
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004331 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregorf20d2722011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004332 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4333 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4334 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
4335 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4336 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004337 }
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004338
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004339 return ICS;
4340}
4341
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004342static ImplicitConversionSequence
4343TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4344 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4345 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004346 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4347 bool AllowExplicit = false);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004348
4349/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4350/// initializer list From.
4351static ImplicitConversionSequence
4352TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4353 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4354 bool InOverloadResolution,
4355 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4356 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4357 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4358 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4359
4360 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4361 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004362 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004363
Sebastian Redlb832f6d2012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004364 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004365 // initialized from init lists.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00004366 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0))
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004367 return Result;
4368
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004369 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4370 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4371 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4372 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4373 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004374 bool toStdInitializerList = false;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004375 QualType X;
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004376 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004377 X = S.Context.getBaseElementType(ToType);
4378 else
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004379 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004380 if (!X.isNull()) {
4381 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4382 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4383 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4384 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4385 InOverloadResolution,
4386 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4387 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4388 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4389 Result = ICS;
4390 break;
4391 }
4392 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4393 if (Result.isBad() ||
4394 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4395 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4396 Result = ICS;
4397 }
Douglas Gregor5b4bf132012-04-04 23:09:20 +00004398
4399 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4400 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4401 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4402 Result.setStandard();
4403 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4404 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4405 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4406 }
4407
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004408 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004409 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004410 return Result;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004411 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004412
4413 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4414 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4415 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4416 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4417 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4418 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004419 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4420 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4421 Result = TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4422 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4423 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4424 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4425 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004426 return Result;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004427 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004428
4429 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4430 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4431 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4432 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004433 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004434 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4435 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4436 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4437 InitializedEntity Entity =
4438 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4439 /*Consumed=*/false);
4440 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) {
4441 Result.setUserDefined();
4442 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4443 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4444 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4445 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4446
4447 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4448 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4449 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Benjamin Kramer83db10e2012-02-02 19:35:29 +00004450 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = 0;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004451 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004452 return Result;
4453 }
4454
4455 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4456 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004457 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4458 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4459 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4460 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4461
4462 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4463
4464 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4465 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4466 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4467 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4468
4469 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4470
4471 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4472 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4473 // type of the resulting function.
4474 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4475 DeclAccessPair Found;
4476 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4477 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4478 T2 = Fn->getType();
4479 }
4480
4481 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4482 bool dummy1 = false;
4483 bool dummy2 = false;
4484 bool dummy3 = false;
4485 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4486 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4487 dummy2, dummy3);
4488
4489 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related)
4490 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType,
4491 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4492 SuppressUserConversions,
4493 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4494 }
4495
4496 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4497 // initializer list.
4498 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4499 InOverloadResolution,
4500 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4501 if (Result.isFailure())
4502 return Result;
4503 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4504 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4505
4506 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4507 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4508 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4509 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4510 Result.UserDefined.After;
4511 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4512 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4513 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4514 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4515 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4516 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4517 } else
4518 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4519 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004520 return Result;
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004521 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004522
4523 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4524 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4525 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4526 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4527 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4528 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004529 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4530 if (NumInits == 1)
4531 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4532 SuppressUserConversions,
4533 InOverloadResolution,
4534 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4535 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4536 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4537 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4538 Result.setStandard();
4539 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCalle14ba2c2012-04-04 02:40:27 +00004540 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4541 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004542 }
Sebastian Redl2422e822012-02-28 23:36:38 +00004543 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004544 return Result;
4545 }
4546
4547 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4548 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4549 return Result;
4550}
4551
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004552/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4553/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4554/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4555/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004556/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregor74e386e2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004557/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004558static ImplicitConversionSequence
4559TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004560 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004561 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004562 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4563 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004564 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4565 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4566 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4567
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004568 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004569 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004570 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4571 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004572 AllowExplicit);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004573
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004574 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4575 SuppressUserConversions,
4576 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004577 InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004578 /*CStyle=*/false,
4579 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004580}
4581
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004582static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4583 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4584 Sema &S,
4585 SourceLocation Loc,
4586 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4587 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4588 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4589 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4590
4591 return !ICS.isBad();
4592}
4593
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004594/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4595/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4596/// expression @p From.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004597static ImplicitConversionSequence
4598TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004599 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004600 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4601 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4602 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl65bdbfa2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004603 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4604 // const volatile object.
4605 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4606 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004607 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004608
4609 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4610 // to exit early.
4611 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004612
4613 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00004614 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004615 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004616 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4617
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004618 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4619 // better have an lvalue.
4620 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4621 }
4622
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004623 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004624
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004625 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004626 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004627 // parameter is
4628 //
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004629 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4630 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4631 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004632 // ref-qualifier
4633 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004634 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004635 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4636 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004637 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004638 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004639 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4640 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4641 // non-constant references.
4642
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004643 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004644 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004645 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004646 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004647 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004648 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
4649 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004650 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004651 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004652
4653 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4654 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004655 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004656 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4657 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4658 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004659 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004660 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004661 else {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004662 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4663 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004664 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004665 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004666
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004667 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4668 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4669 case RQ_None:
4670 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4671 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004672
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004673 case RQ_LValue:
4674 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4675 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004676 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004677 ImplicitParamType);
4678 return ICS;
4679 }
4680 break;
4681
4682 case RQ_RValue:
4683 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4684 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004685 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004686 ImplicitParamType);
4687 return ICS;
4688 }
4689 break;
4690 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004691
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004692 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004693 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004694 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4695 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004696 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004697 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004698 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4699 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004700 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004701 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004702 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4703 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4704 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004705 return ICS;
4706}
4707
4708/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4709/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4710/// expression.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004711ExprResult
4712Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004713 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004714 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004715 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004716 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004717 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004718 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004719
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004720 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004721 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004722 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4723 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004724 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004725 } else {
4726 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4727 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004728 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004729 }
4730
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004731 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4732 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004733 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004734 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4735 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004736 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4737 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4738 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4739 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4740 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4741 if (CVR) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004742 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004743 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4744 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4745 << From->getSourceRange();
4746 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4747 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004748 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004749 }
4750 }
4751
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004752 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004753 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004754 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004755 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004756
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004757 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4758 ExprResult FromRes =
4759 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4760 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4761 return ExprError();
4762 From = FromRes.take();
4763 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004764
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004765 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004766 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Richard Smithacdfa4d2011-11-10 23:32:36 +00004767 From->getValueKind()).take();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004768 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004769}
4770
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004771/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4772/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004773static ImplicitConversionSequence
4774TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregorc6dfe192010-05-08 22:41:50 +00004775 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004776 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonda7a18b2009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004777 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4778 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004779 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004780 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004781 /*CStyle=*/false,
4782 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004783}
4784
4785/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4786/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004787ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004788 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4789 return ExprError();
4790
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004791 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004792 if (!ICS.isBad())
4793 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004794
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004795 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004796 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004797 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004798 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004799 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004800}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004801
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004802/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4803/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4804/// is acceptable.
4805static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4806 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4807 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4808 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4809 // conversions are fine.
4810 switch (SCS.Second) {
4811 case ICK_Identity:
4812 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4813 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
4814 return true;
4815
4816 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
Richard Smith2bcb9842012-09-13 22:00:12 +00004817 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4818 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4819 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4820 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4821 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4822
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004823 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4824 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4825 return false;
4826
4827 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4828 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4829 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4830 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4831 case ICK_Qualification:
4832 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4833 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4834 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4835 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4836 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4837 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4838 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4839 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4840 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4841 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4842 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4843 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4844 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4845 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4846
4847 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4848 break;
4849 }
4850
4851 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4852}
4853
4854/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4855/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4856/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4857ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4858 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4859 CCEKind CCE) {
4860 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus0x && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
4861 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4862
4863 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4864 return ExprError();
4865
4866 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4867 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4868 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4869 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4870 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4871 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4872 // narrowing conversions.
4873 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4874 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4875 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4876 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4877 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4878 /*CStyle=*/false,
4879 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
4880 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0;
4881 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4882 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4883 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004884 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004885 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4886 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4887 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
4888 break;
4889 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4890 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
4891 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
4892 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004893 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004894 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4895 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4896 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
4897 break;
4898 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4899 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4900 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004901 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004902 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
4903 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4904 return ExprError();
4905
4906 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4907 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
4908 }
4909
4910 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
4911 if (Result.isInvalid())
4912 return Result;
4913
4914 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
4915 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004916 QualType PreNarrowingType;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004917 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
4918 PreNarrowingType)) {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004919 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
4920 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
4921 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
4922 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
4923 break;
4924
4925 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00004926 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4927 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
4928 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004929 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004930 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004931 break;
4932
4933 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00004934 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4935 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
4936 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004937 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
4938 break;
4939 }
4940
4941 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
4942 llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
4943 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
4944 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
4945
4946 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context)) {
4947 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
4948 // the AST.
4949 Result = ExprError();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004950 } else {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004951 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004952
4953 if (Notes.empty()) {
4954 // It's a constant expression.
4955 return Result;
4956 }
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004957 }
4958
4959 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
4960 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
4961 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
4962 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
4963 else {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004964 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004965 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
4966 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
4967 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
4968 }
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00004969 return Result;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004970}
4971
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00004972/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
4973/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
4974/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
4975static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4976 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
4977 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
4978 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
4979 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
4980 }
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00004981}
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004982
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00004983/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
4984/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
4985static ImplicitConversionSequence
4986TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
4987 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
4988 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
4989 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
4990 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
4991 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4992 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4993 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
4994 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4995 /*CStyle=*/false,
4996 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
4997
4998 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
4999 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5000 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5001 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5002 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5003 break;
5004
5005 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5006 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5007 break;
5008
5009 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5010 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5011 break;
5012 }
5013
5014 return ICS;
5015}
5016
5017/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5018/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5019ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00005020 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5021 return ExprError();
5022
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005023 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005024 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5025 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005026 if (!ICS.isBad())
5027 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005028 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005029}
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005030
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005031/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5032/// type of a permitted flavor.
5033static bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType(QualType T, bool AllowScopedEnum) {
5034 return AllowScopedEnum ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5035 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5036}
5037
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005038/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005039/// enumeration type.
5040///
5041/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
5042/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
5043/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5044///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005045/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5046/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005047///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005048/// \param From The expression we're converting from.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005049///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005050/// \param Diagnoser Used to output any diagnostics.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005051///
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005052/// \param AllowScopedEnumerations Specifies whether conversions to scoped
5053/// enumerations should be considered.
5054///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005055/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5056/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005057ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005058Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005059 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser,
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005060 bool AllowScopedEnumerations) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005061 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5062 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005063 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005064
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005065 // Process placeholders immediately.
5066 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5067 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
5068 if (result.isInvalid()) return result;
5069 From = result.take();
5070 }
5071
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005072 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
5073 QualType T = From->getType();
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005074 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(T, AllowScopedEnumerations))
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005075 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005076
5077 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5078
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005079 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005080 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
5081 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005082 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005083 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress)
5084 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005085 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005086 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005087
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005088 // We must have a complete class type.
Douglas Gregorf502d8e2012-05-04 16:48:41 +00005089 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005090 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser;
5091 Expr *From;
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005092
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005093 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser, Expr *From)
5094 : TypeDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress), Diagnoser(Diagnoser), From(From) {}
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005095
5096 virtual void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005097 Diagnoser.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005098 }
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005099 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Diagnoser, From);
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005100
5101 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005102 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005103
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005104 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5105 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
5106 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
5107 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
5108 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005109
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005110 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (Conversions->size() > 1);
5111
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005112 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005113 E = Conversions->end();
5114 I != E;
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005115 ++I) {
5116 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005117 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) {
5118 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(
5119 Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(),
5120 AllowScopedEnumerations)) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005121 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
5122 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5123 else
5124 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5125 }
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005126 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005127 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005128
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005129 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5130 case 0:
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005131 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Diagnoser.Suppress) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005132 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5133 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5134 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005135
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005136 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5137 // conversion; use it.
5138 QualType ConvTy
5139 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5140 std::string TypeStr;
Douglas Gregor8987b232011-09-27 23:30:47 +00005141 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, getPrintingPolicy());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005142
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005143 Diagnoser.diagnoseExplicitConv(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy)
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005144 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5145 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5146 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
5147 ")");
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005148 Diagnoser.noteExplicitConv(*this, Conversion, ConvTy);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005149
5150 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005151 // explicit conversion function.
5152 if (isSFINAEContext())
5153 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005154
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005155 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005156 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5157 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005158 if (Result.isInvalid())
5159 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005160 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5161 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5162 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5163 Result.get(), 0,
5164 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005165 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005166
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005167 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5168 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005169
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005170 case 1: {
5171 // Apply this conversion.
5172 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5173 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005174
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005175 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5176 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5177 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005178 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005179 if (!Diagnoser.SuppressConversion) {
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005180 if (isSFINAEContext())
5181 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005182
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005183 Diagnoser.diagnoseConversion(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5184 << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005185 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005186
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005187 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5188 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005189 if (Result.isInvalid())
5190 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005191 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5192 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5193 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5194 Result.get(), 0,
5195 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005196 break;
5197 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005198
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005199 default:
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005200 if (Diagnoser.Suppress)
5201 return ExprError();
Richard Smith282e7e62012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005202
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005203 Diagnoser.diagnoseAmbiguous(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005204 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5205 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
5206 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5207 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005208 Diagnoser.noteAmbiguous(*this, Conv, ConvTy);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005209 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005210 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005211 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005212
Richard Smith282e7e62012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005213 if (!isIntegralOrEnumerationType(From->getType(), AllowScopedEnumerations) &&
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005214 !Diagnoser.Suppress) {
5215 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, From->getType())
5216 << From->getSourceRange();
5217 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005218
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005219 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005220}
5221
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005222/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005223/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
5224/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5225/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005226///
James Dennett699c9042012-06-15 07:13:21 +00005227/// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005228/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5229/// code completion.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005230void
5231Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005232 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005233 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005234 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle2b68332009-04-12 17:16:29 +00005235 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005236 bool PartialOverloading,
5237 bool AllowExplicit) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005238 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005239 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005240 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005241 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00005242 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005243
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005244 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005245 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5246 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5247 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5248 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5249 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005250 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5251 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5252 // is irrelevant.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005253 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005254 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005255 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005256 return;
5257 }
5258 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5259 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005260 }
5261
Douglas Gregorfd476482009-11-13 23:59:09 +00005262 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005263 return;
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005264
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005265 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005266 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005267
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005268 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
5269 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5270 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5271 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
5272 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005273 if (Args.size() == 1 &&
Douglas Gregor6493cc52010-11-08 17:16:59 +00005274 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor12116062010-02-21 18:30:38 +00005275 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5276 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005277 return;
5278 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005279
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005280 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005281 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005282 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005283 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005284 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005285 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005286 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005287 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005288
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005289 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5290
5291 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5292 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5293 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005294 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor5bd1a112009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005295 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005296 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005297 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005298 return;
5299 }
5300
5301 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5302 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5303 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5304 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5305 // exactly m parameters.
5306 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005307 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005308 // Not enough arguments.
5309 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005310 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005311 return;
5312 }
5313
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005314 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005315 if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005316 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5317 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5318 Candidate.Viable = false;
5319 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5320 return;
5321 }
5322
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005323 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5324 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005325 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005326 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5327 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5328 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5329 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5330 // parameter of F.
5331 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005332 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005333 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005334 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005335 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5336 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005337 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005338 AllowExplicit);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005339 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5340 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005341 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005342 break;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005343 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005344 } else {
5345 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5346 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5347 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005348 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005349 }
5350 }
5351}
5352
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005353/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
5354/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005355void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005356 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005357 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005358 bool SuppressUserConversions,
5359 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005360 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005361 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5362 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005363 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005364 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005365 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005366 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005367 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5368 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005369 else
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005370 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005371 SuppressUserConversions);
5372 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005373 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005374 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5375 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005376 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005377 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005378 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005379 Args[0]->getType(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005380 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5381 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005382 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005383 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005384 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005385 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005386 }
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005387 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005388}
5389
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005390/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5391/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005392void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005393 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005394 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005395 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5396 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005397 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005398 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005399 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005400
5401 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5402 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005403
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005404 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5405 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5406 "Expected a member function template");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005407 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5408 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005409 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5410 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005411 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005412 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005413 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005414 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5415 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005416 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005417 }
5418}
5419
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005420/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5421/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5422/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5423/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5424/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5425/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005426/// operators.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005427void
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005428Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005429 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005430 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005431 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005432 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005433 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005434 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005435 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005436 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005437 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5438 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005439
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005440 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5441 return;
5442
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005443 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005444 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005445
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005446 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005447 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005448 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005449 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005450 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005451 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005452 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005453
5454 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5455
5456 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5457 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5458 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005459 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005460 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005461 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005462 return;
5463 }
5464
5465 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5466 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5467 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5468 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5469 // exactly m parameters.
5470 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005471 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005472 // Not enough arguments.
5473 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005474 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005475 return;
5476 }
5477
5478 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005479
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005480 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005481 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5482 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5483 else {
5484 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5485 // parameter.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005486 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005487 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5488 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005489 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005490 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005491 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005492 return;
5493 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005494 }
5495
5496 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5497 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005498 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005499 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5500 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5501 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5502 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5503 // parameter of F.
5504 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005505 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005506 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005507 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005508 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5509 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005510 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005511 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005512 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005513 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005514 break;
5515 }
5516 } else {
5517 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5518 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5519 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005520 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005521 }
5522 }
5523}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005524
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005525/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
5526/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
5527/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005528void
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005529Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005530 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005531 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005532 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005533 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005534 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005535 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005536 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005537 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005538 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
5539 return;
5540
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005541 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005542 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005543 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005544 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005545 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5546 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5547 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5548 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5549 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005550 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005551 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5552 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005553 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5554 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005555 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005556 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5557 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
5558 Candidate.Viable = false;
5559 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5560 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5561 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005562 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005563 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005564 Info);
5565 return;
5566 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005567
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005568 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5569 // deduction as a candidate.
5570 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005571 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005572 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005573 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005574 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
5575 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005576}
5577
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005578/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
5579/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
5580/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005581void
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005582Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005583 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005584 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005585 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005586 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005587 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005588 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5589 return;
5590
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005591 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005592 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005593 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005594 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005595 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5596 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5597 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5598 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5599 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005600 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005601 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5602 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005603 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5604 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005605 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005606 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005607 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5608 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005609 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005610 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5611 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005612 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005613 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005614 Info);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005615 return;
5616 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005617
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005618 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5619 // deduction as a candidate.
5620 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005621 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005622 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005623}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005624
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005625/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005626/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005627/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005628/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005629/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
5630/// conversion function produces).
5631void
5632Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005633 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005634 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005635 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5636 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005637 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5638 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005639 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005640 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5641 return;
5642
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005643 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005644 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005645
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005646 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005647 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005648 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005649 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005650 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005651 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005652 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005653 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00005654 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005655 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005656 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005657
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005658 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005659 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
5660 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005661 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005662 //
5663 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5664 // object parameter.
5665 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
5666 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
5667 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
5668 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
5669 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005670
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005671 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005672 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
5673 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005674 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005675
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005676 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005677 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005678 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005679 return;
5680 }
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005681
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005682 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005683 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
5684 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
5685 QualType FromCanon
5686 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
5687 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
5688 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
5689 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005690 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005691 return;
5692 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005693
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005694 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
5695 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
5696 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
5697 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
5698 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
5699 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
5700 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
5701 // well-formed.
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +00005702 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005703 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00005704 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
5705 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005706 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00005707 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005708
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005709 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
5710 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor7d14d382010-11-13 19:36:57 +00005711 Candidate.Viable = false;
5712 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5713 return;
5714 }
5715
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005716 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005717
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005718 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00005719 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
5720 // allocator).
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005721 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +00005722 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, MultiExprArg(), CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregor0a0d1ac2009-11-17 21:16:22 +00005723 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005724 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005725 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005726 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005727 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5728 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005729
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005730 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005731 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5732 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005733
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005734 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
5735 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005736 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005737 // shall have exact match rank.
5738 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5739 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
5740 Candidate.Viable = false;
5741 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
5742 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005743
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005744 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
5745 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
5746 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
5747 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
5748 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005749 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005750 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
5751 Candidate.Viable = false;
5752 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5753 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005754 break;
5755
5756 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5757 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005758 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005759 break;
5760
5761 default:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005762 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005763 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
5764 }
5765}
5766
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005767/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
5768/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
5769/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
5770/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
5771/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005772void
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005773Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005774 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005775 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005776 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5777 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5778 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5779 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
5780
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005781 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5782 return;
5783
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005784 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005785 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5786 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005787 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005788 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005789 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005790 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5791 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5792 Candidate.Viable = false;
5793 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5794 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5795 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005796 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005797 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005798 Info);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005799 return;
5800 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005801
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005802 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
5803 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
5804 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005805 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005806 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005807}
5808
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005809/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
5810/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
5811/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
5812/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
5813/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
5814void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005815 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005816 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00005817 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005818 Expr *Object,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005819 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005820 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005821 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5822 return;
5823
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005824 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005825 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005826
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005827 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005828 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005829 Candidate.Function = 0;
5830 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
5831 Candidate.Viable = true;
5832 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005833 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005834 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005835
5836 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5837 // object parameter.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005838 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005839 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005840 Object->Classify(Context),
5841 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005842 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005843 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005844 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005845 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005846 return;
5847 }
5848
5849 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
5850 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
5851 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005852 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005853 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian966256a2009-11-06 00:23:08 +00005854 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005855 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005856 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00005857 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005858 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005859 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
5860 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5861
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005862 // Find the
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005863 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5864
5865 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5866 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5867 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005868 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005869 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005870 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005871 return;
5872 }
5873
5874 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
5875 // we have enough arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005876 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005877 // Not enough arguments.
5878 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005879 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005880 return;
5881 }
5882
5883 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5884 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005885 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005886 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5887 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5888 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5889 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5890 // parameter of F.
5891 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005892 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005893 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005894 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005895 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5896 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005897 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005898 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005899 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005900 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005901 break;
5902 }
5903 } else {
5904 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5905 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5906 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005907 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005908 }
5909 }
5910}
5911
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005912/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
5913/// member functions.
5914///
5915/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
5916/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
5917/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
5918/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
5919/// [over.match.oper]).
5920void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5921 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5922 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5923 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5924 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005925 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
5926
5927 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5928 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
5929 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
5930 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
5931 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
5932 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
5933 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
5934 // constructed as follows:
5935 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005936
5937 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
5938 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
5939 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
5940 // empty.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005941 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005942 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005943 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0))
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005944 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005945
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00005946 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
5947 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
5948 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
5949
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005950 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00005951 OperEnd = Operators.end();
5952 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005953 ++Oper)
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005954 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005955 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005956 CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005957 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005958 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005959}
5960
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005961/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
5962/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
5963/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005964/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
5965/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005966/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
5967/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
5968/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005969void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005970 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005971 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005972 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
5973 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005974 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005975 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005976
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005977 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005978 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005979 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005980 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00005981 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005982 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005983 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
5984 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
5985 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
5986
5987 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5988 // arguments.
5989 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005990 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005991 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005992 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
5993 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
5994 // left operand are restricted as follows:
5995 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
5996 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
5997 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005998 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00005999 //
6000 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
6001 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
6002 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
6003 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006004 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006005 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006006 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006007 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6008 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006009 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006010 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006011 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006012 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006013 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6014 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006015 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006016 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006017 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006018 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006019 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006020 break;
6021 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006022 }
6023}
6024
6025/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
6026/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
6027/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
6028/// enumeration types.
6029class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
6030 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006031 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006032
6033 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
6034 /// built-in candidates.
6035 TypeSet PointerTypes;
6036
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006037 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
6038 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6039 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
6040
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006041 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
6042 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6043 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
6044
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006045 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006046 /// candidates.
6047 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006048
6049 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
6050 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
6051
6052 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
6053 /// were present in the candidate set.
6054 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
6055
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006056 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
6057 /// candidate set.
6058 bool HasNullPtrType;
6059
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00006060 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
6061 /// candidate type set.
6062 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006063
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006064 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
6065 ASTContext &Context;
6066
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006067 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6068 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006069 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006070
6071public:
6072 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006073 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006074
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006075 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006076 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
6077 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006078 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006079 SemaRef(SemaRef),
6080 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006081
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006082 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006083 SourceLocation Loc,
6084 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006085 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6086 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006087
6088 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
6089 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
6090
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006091 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006092 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
6093
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006094 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
6095 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
6096
6097 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
6098 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
6099
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006100 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
6101 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
6102
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006103 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006104 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006105
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006106 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
6107 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006108
6109 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
6110 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006111 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006112};
6113
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006114/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006115/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6116/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6117/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6118/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6119/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6120/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006121///
6122/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006123bool
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006124BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6125 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006126
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006127 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006128 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006129 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006130
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006131 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006132 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006133 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006134 if (!PointerTy) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006135 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6136 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6137 buildObjCPtr = true;
6138 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006139 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006140 }
6141
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006142 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6143 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6144 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6145 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6146 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6147 return true;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006148
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006149 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006150 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6151 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006152
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006153 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6154 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6155 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006156 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006157 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006158
6159 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
6160 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
6161 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
6162 (!hasRestrict ||
6163 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
6164 continue;
6165
6166 // Build qualified pointee type.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006167 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006168
6169 // Build qualified pointer type.
6170 QualType QPointerTy;
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006171 if (!buildObjCPtr)
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006172 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006173 else
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006174 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6175
6176 // Insert qualified pointer type.
6177 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006178 }
6179
6180 return true;
6181}
6182
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006183/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6184/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6185/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6186/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6187/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6188/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6189/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006190///
6191/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006192bool
6193BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6194 QualType Ty) {
6195 // Insert this type.
6196 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6197 return false;
6198
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006199 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6200 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006201
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006202 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006203 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6204 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6205 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6206 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6207 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6208 return true;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006209 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6210
6211 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6212 // qualifiers.
6213 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6214 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6215 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006216
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006217 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006218 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6219 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006220 }
6221
6222 return true;
6223}
6224
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006225/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6226/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006227/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6228/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006229/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6230/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6231/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6232/// type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006233void
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006234BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006235 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006236 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006237 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6238 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006239 // Only deal with canonical types.
6240 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6241
6242 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6243 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006244 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006245 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6246
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00006247 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6248 if (Ty->isArrayType())
6249 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6250
6251 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00006252 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006253
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006254 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6255 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6256 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6257
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006258 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6259 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6260 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6261
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006262 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6263 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6264 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006265 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6266 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006267 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006268 return;
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006269 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6270 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6271 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6272 return;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006273 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006274 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006275 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006276 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006277 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6278 // extension.
6279 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006280 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006281 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6282 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006283 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6284 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6285 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6286 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006287
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006288 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
6289 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
6290 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6291 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
6292 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
6293 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6294 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6295 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006296
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006297 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6298 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6299 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6300 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006301
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006302 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6303 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6304 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6305 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006306 }
6307 }
6308 }
6309}
6310
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006311/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6312/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6313/// given type to the candidate set.
6314static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6315 QualType T,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006316 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006317 unsigned NumArgs,
6318 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6319 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006320
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006321 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6322 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6323 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6324 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6325 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006326
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006327 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6328 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006329 ParamTypes[0]
6330 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006331 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6332 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006333 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006334 }
6335}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006336
Sebastian Redl9994a342009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006337/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6338/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006339static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6340 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6341 const RecordType *TyRec;
6342 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6343 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregorb86cf0c2010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006344 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006345 else
6346 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6347 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006348 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006349 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6350 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6351 return VRQuals;
6352 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006353
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006354 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall86ff3082010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006355 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6356 return VRQuals;
6357
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006358 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl9994a342009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006359 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006360
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006361 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006362 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006363 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6364 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6365 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6366 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006367 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6368 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6369 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6370 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6371 // as see them.
6372 bool done = false;
6373 while (!done) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006374 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6375 VRQuals.addRestrict();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006376 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6377 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006378 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006379 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6380 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6381 else
6382 done = true;
6383 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6384 VRQuals.addVolatile();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006385 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6386 return VRQuals;
6387 }
6388 }
6389 }
6390 return VRQuals;
6391}
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006392
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006393namespace {
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006394
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006395/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6396/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6397/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6398/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6399class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006400 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6401 Sema &S;
6402 Expr **Args;
6403 unsigned NumArgs;
6404 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006405 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006406 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006407 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006408
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006409 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6410 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006411 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6412 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006413 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006414 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006415 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006416 LastPromotedIntegralType = 11;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006417 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006418 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11;
6419 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006420
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006421 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6422 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6423 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6424 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6425 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6426 // Start of promoted types.
6427 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6428 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
6429 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006430
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006431 // Start of integral types.
6432 &ASTContext::IntTy,
6433 &ASTContext::LongTy,
6434 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006435 &ASTContext::Int128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006436 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
6437 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
6438 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006439 &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006440 // End of promoted types.
6441
6442 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
6443 &ASTContext::CharTy,
6444 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
6445 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
6446 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
6447 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
6448 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
6449 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
6450 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
6451 // End of integral types.
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006452 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006453 };
6454 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
6455 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006456
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006457 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
6458 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
6459 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
6460 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
6461 // The rules are basically:
6462 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
6463 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
6464 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
6465 // - use the larger type
6466 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
6467 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
6468 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
6469 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
6470 // better not to make any assumptions).
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006471 // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms.
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006472 enum PromotedType {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006473 Dep=-1,
6474 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006475 };
Nuno Lopes79e244f2012-04-21 14:45:25 +00006476 static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006477 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006478/* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
6479/* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
6480/*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
6481/* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6482/* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, S128, Dep, UL, ULL, U128 },
6483/* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, S128, Dep, Dep, ULL, U128 },
6484/*S128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 },
6485/* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6486/* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, S128, UL, UL, ULL, U128 },
6487/* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, S128, ULL, ULL, ULL, U128 },
6488/*U128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 },
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006489 };
6490
6491 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6492 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6493 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
6494
6495 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006496 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006497
6498 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
6499 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006500 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
6501 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006502 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
6503 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
6504
6505 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
6506 if (LW > RW) return LT;
6507 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
6508
6509 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
6510 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
6511 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
6512 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
6513 }
6514
Chandler Carruth3c69dc42010-12-12 09:22:45 +00006515 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
6516 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006517 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006518 bool HasVolatile,
6519 bool HasRestrict) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006520 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6521 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
6522 S.Context.IntTy
6523 };
6524
6525 // Non-volatile version.
6526 if (NumArgs == 1)
6527 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6528 else
6529 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6530
6531 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
6532 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
6533 if (HasVolatile) {
6534 ParamTypes[0] =
6535 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6536 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
6537 if (NumArgs == 1)
6538 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6539 else
6540 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6541 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006542
6543 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
6544 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
6545 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
6546 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
6547 ParamTypes[0]
6548 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6549 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
6550 if (NumArgs == 1)
6551 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6552 else
6553 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6554
6555 if (HasVolatile) {
6556 ParamTypes[0]
6557 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6558 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
6559 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
6560 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
6561 if (NumArgs == 1)
6562 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1,
6563 CandidateSet);
6564 else
6565 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6566 }
6567 }
6568
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006569 }
6570
6571public:
6572 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
6573 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6574 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006575 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006576 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006577 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
6578 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
6579 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006580 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
6581 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006582 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
6583 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
6584 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006585 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006586 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006587 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006588 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006589 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006590 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
6591 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006592 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006593 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006594 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006595 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
6596 }
6597
6598 // C++ [over.built]p3:
6599 //
6600 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
6601 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
6602 // functions of the form
6603 //
6604 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
6605 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
6606 //
6607 // C++ [over.built]p4:
6608 //
6609 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
6610 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
6611 // candidate operator functions of the form
6612 //
6613 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
6614 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
6615 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006616 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6617 return;
6618
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006619 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
6620 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
6621 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006622 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006623 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
6624 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006625 }
6626 }
6627
6628 // C++ [over.built]p5:
6629 //
6630 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6631 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
6632 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6633 //
6634 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
6635 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
6636 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
6637 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
6638 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
6639 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6640 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6641 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6642 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6643 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006644 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006645 continue;
6646
6647 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006648 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6649 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
6650 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
6651 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006652 }
6653 }
6654
6655 // C++ [over.built]p6:
6656 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
6657 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6658 //
6659 // T& operator*(T*);
6660 //
6661 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006662 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006663 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006664 // T& operator*(T*);
6665 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
6666 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6667 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6668 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6669 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6670 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6671 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006672 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6673 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006674
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006675 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
6676 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
6677 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006678
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006679 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
6680 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6681 }
6682 }
6683
6684 // C++ [over.built]p9:
6685 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
6686 // operator functions of the form
6687 //
6688 // T operator+(T);
6689 // T operator-(T);
6690 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006691 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6692 return;
6693
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006694 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6695 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006696 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006697 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6698 }
6699
6700 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
6701 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6702 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6703 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6704 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6705 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6706 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6707 }
6708 }
6709
6710 // C++ [over.built]p8:
6711 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
6712 // the form
6713 //
6714 // T* operator+(T*);
6715 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
6716 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6717 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6718 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6719 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6720 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6721 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6722 }
6723 }
6724
6725 // C++ [over.built]p10:
6726 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
6727 // operator functions of the form
6728 //
6729 // T operator~(T);
6730 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006731 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6732 return;
6733
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006734 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6735 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006736 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006737 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6738 }
6739
6740 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
6741 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6742 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6743 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6744 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6745 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6746 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6747 }
6748 }
6749
6750 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
6751 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
6752 // functions of the form
6753 //
6754 // bool operator==(T,T);
6755 // bool operator!=(T,T);
6756 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
6757 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6758 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6759
6760 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6761 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6762 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6763 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6764 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
6765 ++MemPtr) {
6766 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6767 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6768 continue;
6769
6770 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
6771 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6772 CandidateSet);
6773 }
6774 }
6775 }
6776
6777 // C++ [over.built]p15:
6778 //
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006779 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
6780 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006781 //
6782 // bool operator<(T, T);
6783 // bool operator>(T, T);
6784 // bool operator<=(T, T);
6785 // bool operator>=(T, T);
6786 // bool operator==(T, T);
6787 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006788 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006789 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6790 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
6791 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
6792 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
6793 // candidate.
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006794 //
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006795 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
6796 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
6797 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
6798 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006799 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
6800 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
6801 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
6802 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
6803
6804 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6805 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
6806 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
6807 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
6808 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6809 C != CEnd; ++C) {
6810 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
6811 continue;
6812
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006813 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
6814 continue;
6815
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006816 QualType FirstParamType =
6817 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6818 QualType SecondParamType =
6819 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6820
6821 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
6822 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
6823 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
6824 continue;
6825
6826 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
6827 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
6828 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
6829 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
6830 }
6831 }
6832 }
6833
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006834 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6835 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6836
6837 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6838 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6839 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
6840 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
6841 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6842 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6843 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6844 continue;
6845
6846 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6847 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6848 CandidateSet);
6849 }
6850 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6851 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6852 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6853 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6854 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
6855
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006856 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
6857 // candidate exists.
6858 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
6859 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
6860 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006861 continue;
6862
6863 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006864 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6865 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006866 }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006867
6868 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
6869 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
6870 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
6871 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
6872 NullPtrTy))) {
6873 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
6874 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6875 CandidateSet);
6876 }
6877 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006878 }
6879 }
6880
6881 // C++ [over.built]p13:
6882 //
6883 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
6884 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6885 //
6886 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6887 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
6888 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6889 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6890 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
6891 //
6892 // C++ [over.built]p14:
6893 //
6894 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
6895 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6896 //
6897 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6898 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
6899 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6900 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6901
6902 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
6903 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
6904 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6905 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6906 };
6907 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6908 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
6909 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
6910 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006911 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
6912 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
6913 continue;
6914
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006915 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
6916 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
6917 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
6918 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6919 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
6920 CandidateSet);
6921 }
6922 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
6923 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6924 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6925 continue;
6926
6927 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6928 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
6929 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6930 }
6931 }
6932 }
6933 }
6934
6935 // C++ [over.built]p12:
6936 //
6937 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
6938 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6939 //
6940 // LR operator*(L, R);
6941 // LR operator/(L, R);
6942 // LR operator+(L, R);
6943 // LR operator-(L, R);
6944 // bool operator<(L, R);
6945 // bool operator>(L, R);
6946 // bool operator<=(L, R);
6947 // bool operator>=(L, R);
6948 // bool operator==(L, R);
6949 // bool operator!=(L, R);
6950 //
6951 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6952 // between types L and R.
6953 //
6954 // C++ [over.built]p24:
6955 //
6956 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
6957 // candidate operator functions of the form
6958 //
6959 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
6960 //
6961 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6962 // between types L and R.
6963 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
6964 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006965 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6966 return;
6967
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006968 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6969 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
6970 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6971 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006972 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
6973 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006974 QualType Result =
6975 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006976 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006977 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6978 }
6979 }
6980
6981 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
6982 // conditional operator for vector types.
6983 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6984 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6985 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6986 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
6987 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6988 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
6989 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
6990 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
6991 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
6992 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
6993 if (!isComparison) {
6994 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
6995 Result = *Vec1;
6996 else
6997 Result = *Vec2;
6998 }
6999
7000 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7001 }
7002 }
7003 }
7004
7005 // C++ [over.built]p17:
7006 //
7007 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
7008 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7009 //
7010 // LR operator%(L, R);
7011 // LR operator&(L, R);
7012 // LR operator^(L, R);
7013 // LR operator|(L, R);
7014 // L operator<<(L, R);
7015 // L operator>>(L, R);
7016 //
7017 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7018 // between types L and R.
7019 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007020 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7021 return;
7022
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007023 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7024 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
7025 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7026 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007027 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7028 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007029 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
7030 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007031 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007032 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7033 }
7034 }
7035 }
7036
7037 // C++ [over.built]p20:
7038 //
7039 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
7040 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
7041 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7042 //
7043 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
7044 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7045 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7046 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7047
7048 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7049 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7050 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7051 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7052 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7053 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7054 continue;
7055
7056 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
7057 CandidateSet);
7058 }
7059
7060 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7061 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7062 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7063 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7064 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7065 continue;
7066
7067 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
7068 CandidateSet);
7069 }
7070 }
7071 }
7072
7073 // C++ [over.built]p19:
7074 //
7075 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
7076 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
7077 // of the form
7078 //
7079 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
7080 //
7081 // C++ [over.built]p21:
7082 //
7083 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7084 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
7085 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7086 //
7087 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7088 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7089 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7090 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7091 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7092
7093 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7094 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7095 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7096 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7097 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
7098 if (isEqualOp)
7099 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007100 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7101 continue;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007102
7103 // non-volatile version
7104 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7105 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7106 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7107 };
7108 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7109 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
7110
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007111 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7112 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7113 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007114 // volatile version
7115 ParamTypes[0] =
7116 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
7117 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7118 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7119 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007120
7121 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7122 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7123 // restrict version
7124 ParamTypes[0]
7125 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7126 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7127 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7128
7129 if (NeedVolatile) {
7130 // volatile restrict version
7131 ParamTypes[0]
7132 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7133 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7134 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7135 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7136 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7137 CandidateSet,
7138 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7139 }
7140 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007141 }
7142
7143 if (isEqualOp) {
7144 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7145 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7146 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7147 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7148 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
7149 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7150 continue;
7151
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007152 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7153 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7154 *Ptr,
7155 };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007156
7157 // non-volatile version
7158 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7159 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7160
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007161 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7162 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7163 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007164 // volatile version
7165 ParamTypes[0] =
7166 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007167 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7168 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007169 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007170
7171 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7172 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7173 // restrict version
7174 ParamTypes[0]
7175 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7176 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7177 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7178
7179 if (NeedVolatile) {
7180 // volatile restrict version
7181 ParamTypes[0]
7182 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7183 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7184 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7185 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7186 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7187 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7188
7189 }
7190 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007191 }
7192 }
7193 }
7194
7195 // C++ [over.built]p18:
7196 //
7197 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
7198 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
7199 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
7200 // the form
7201 //
7202 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
7203 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
7204 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
7205 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
7206 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
7207 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007208 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7209 return;
7210
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007211 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
7212 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7213 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7214 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007215 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007216
7217 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7218 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007219 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007220 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7221 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7222
7223 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7224 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7225 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007226 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007227 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007228 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7229 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007230 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7231 }
7232 }
7233 }
7234
7235 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7236 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7237 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7238 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7239 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7240 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7241 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7242 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7243 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7244 QualType ParamTypes[2];
7245 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7246 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7247 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
7248 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7249 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7250
7251 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7252 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7253 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7254 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007255 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7256 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007257 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7258 }
7259 }
7260 }
7261 }
7262
7263 // C++ [over.built]p22:
7264 //
7265 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7266 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7267 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7268 //
7269 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7270 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7271 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7272 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7273 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7274 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7275 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007276 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7277 return;
7278
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007279 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7280 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7281 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7282 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007283 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007284
7285 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7286 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007287 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007288 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7289 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7290 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007291 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007292 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7293 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7294 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7295 CandidateSet);
7296 }
7297 }
7298 }
7299 }
7300
7301 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7302 //
7303 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7304 //
7305 // bool operator!(bool);
7306 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
7307 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
7308 void addExclaimOverload() {
7309 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
7310 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
7311 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7312 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7313 }
7314 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7315 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
7316 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7317 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7318 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7319 }
7320
7321 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7322 //
7323 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7324 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7325 //
7326 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7327 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7328 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7329 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
7330 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7331 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7332 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7333 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7334 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7335 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7336 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7337 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007338 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7339 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007340
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007341 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7342
7343 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
7344 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7345 }
7346
7347 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7348 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7349 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7350 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7351 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7352 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007353 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7354 continue;
7355
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007356 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7357
7358 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
7359 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7360 }
7361 }
7362
7363 // C++ [over.built]p11:
7364 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7365 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7366 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7367 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7368 //
7369 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7370 //
7371 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7372 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7373 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7374 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7375 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7376 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7377 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7378 QualType C1;
7379 QualifierCollector Q1;
7380 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7381 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7382 continue;
7383 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7384 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7385 // volatile/restrict type.
7386 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7387 continue;
7388 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7389 continue;
7390 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7391 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7392 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7393 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7394 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7395 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7396 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7397 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7398 break;
7399 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7400 // build CV12 T&
7401 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7402 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7403 T.isVolatileQualified())
7404 continue;
7405 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7406 T.isRestrictQualified())
7407 continue;
7408 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7409 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
7410 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7411 }
7412 }
7413 }
7414
7415 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7416 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7417 // therefore added as binary.
7418 //
7419 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7420 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7421 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7422 //
7423 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7424 //
7425 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7426 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7427 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7428
7429 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7430 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7431 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7432 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7433 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7434 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7435 continue;
7436
7437 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7438 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7439 }
7440
7441 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7442 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7443 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7444 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7445 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7446 continue;
7447
7448 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7449 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7450 }
7451
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007452 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus0x) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007453 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7454 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7455 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7456 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7457 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
7458 continue;
7459
7460 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7461 continue;
7462
7463 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
7464 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7465 }
7466 }
7467 }
7468 }
7469};
7470
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007471} // end anonymous namespace
7472
7473/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
7474/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
7475/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
7476/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
7477/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
7478void
7479Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7480 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7481 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7482 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007483 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
7484 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007485 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
7486 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00007487 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7488 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian8621d012009-10-19 21:30:45 +00007489 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
7490 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007491
7492 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
7493 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007494 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007495 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
7496 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
7497 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
7498 OpLoc,
7499 true,
7500 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
7501 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
7502 Op == OO_PipePipe),
7503 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007504 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
7505 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
7506 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
7507 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
7508 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007509 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007510
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007511 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
7512 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor25aaff92011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007513 //
7514 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
7515 // 'bool' overloads.
7516 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
7517 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007518 return;
7519
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007520 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
7521 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
7522 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007523 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007524 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
7525
7526 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007527 switch (Op) {
7528 case OO_None:
7529 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007530 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007531
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007532 case OO_New:
7533 case OO_Delete:
7534 case OO_Array_New:
7535 case OO_Array_Delete:
7536 case OO_Call:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007537 llvm_unreachable(
7538 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007539
7540 case OO_Comma:
7541 case OO_Arrow:
7542 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7543 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7544 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007545 break;
7546
7547 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007548 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007549 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007550 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007551
7552 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007553 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007554 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007555 } else {
7556 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
7557 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7558 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007559 break;
7560
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007561 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007562 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007563 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
7564 else
7565 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7566 break;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007567
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007568 case OO_Slash:
7569 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007570 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007571
7572 case OO_PlusPlus:
7573 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007574 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7575 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007576 break;
7577
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00007578 case OO_EqualEqual:
7579 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007580 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007581 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007582
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007583 case OO_Less:
7584 case OO_Greater:
7585 case OO_LessEqual:
7586 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007587 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007588 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
7589 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007590
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007591 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007592 case OO_Caret:
7593 case OO_Pipe:
7594 case OO_LessLess:
7595 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007596 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007597 break;
7598
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007599 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
7600 if (NumArgs == 1)
7601 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7602 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7603 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
7604 break;
7605
7606 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7607 break;
7608
7609 case OO_Tilde:
7610 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
7611 break;
7612
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007613 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007614 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00007615 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007616
7617 case OO_PlusEqual:
7618 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007619 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007620 // Fall through.
7621
7622 case OO_StarEqual:
7623 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007624 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007625 break;
7626
7627 case OO_PercentEqual:
7628 case OO_LessLessEqual:
7629 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
7630 case OO_AmpEqual:
7631 case OO_CaretEqual:
7632 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007633 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007634 break;
7635
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007636 case OO_Exclaim:
7637 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007638 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007639
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007640 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007641 case OO_PipePipe:
7642 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007643 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007644
7645 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007646 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007647 break;
7648
7649 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007650 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007651 break;
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007652
7653 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007654 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007655 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7656 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007657 }
7658}
7659
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007660/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
7661/// to the set of overloading candidates.
7662///
7663/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
7664/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
7665/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
7666/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007667void
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007668Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00007669 bool Operator, SourceLocation Loc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007670 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007671 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007672 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007673 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007674 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007675
John McCalla113e722010-01-26 06:04:06 +00007676 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
7677 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
7678 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
7679 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
7680 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
7681 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
7682
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007683 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007684 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Loc, Args, Fns);
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007685
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007686 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007687 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
7688 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7689 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007690 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007691 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007692 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007693 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007694 }
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007695
7696 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
7697 // set.
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007698 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007699 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007700 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007701 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007702 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007703
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007704 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
7705 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007706 } else
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007707 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007708 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007709 Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007710 }
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007711}
7712
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007713/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
7714/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007715bool
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007716isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007717 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
7718 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007719 SourceLocation Loc,
7720 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007721 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
7722 // functions.
7723 if (!Cand2.Viable)
7724 return Cand1.Viable;
7725 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
7726 return false;
7727
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007728 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
7729 //
7730 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
7731 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
7732 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
7733 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
7734 unsigned StartArg = 0;
7735 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
7736 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007737
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007738 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007739 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
7740 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007741 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00007742 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
7743 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007744 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007745 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007746 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7747 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007748 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
7749 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7750 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7751 HasBetterConversion = true;
7752 break;
7753
7754 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7755 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7756 return false;
7757
7758 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7759 // Do nothing.
7760 break;
7761 }
7762 }
7763
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007764 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007765 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007766 if (HasBetterConversion)
7767 return true;
7768
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007769 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007770 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorccd47132010-06-08 21:03:17 +00007771 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007772 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
7773 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007774
7775 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
7776 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
7777 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007778 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor1f561c12009-08-02 23:46:29 +00007779 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007780 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007781 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007782 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7783 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7784 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007785 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5c7bf422011-01-11 17:34:58 +00007786 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007787 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007788 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007789 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007790
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007791 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
7792 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
7793 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
7794 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
7795 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
7796 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007797 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007798 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007799 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00007800 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
7801 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
7802 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
7803 // pointer or block.
7804 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind FuncResult
7805 = compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
7806 if (FuncResult != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
7807 return FuncResult;
7808
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007809 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
7810 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007811 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
7812 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7813 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7814 return true;
7815
7816 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7817 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7818 return false;
7819
7820 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7821 // Do nothing
7822 break;
7823 }
7824 }
7825
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007826 return false;
7827}
7828
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007829/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007830/// within an overload candidate set.
7831///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00007832/// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007833/// which overload resolution occurs.
7834///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00007835/// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
7836/// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007837///
7838/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007839OverloadingResult
7840OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007841 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007842 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007843 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007844 Best = end();
7845 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
7846 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007847 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007848 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007849 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007850 }
7851
7852 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007853 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007854 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
7855
7856 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
7857 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007858 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007859 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007860 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007861 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007862 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007863 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007864 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007865 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007866 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007867
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007868 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007869 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00007870 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
7871 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007872 return OR_Deleted;
7873
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007874 return OR_Success;
7875}
7876
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007877namespace {
7878
7879enum OverloadCandidateKind {
7880 oc_function,
7881 oc_method,
7882 oc_constructor,
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007883 oc_function_template,
7884 oc_method_template,
7885 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007886 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
7887 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007888 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007889 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007890 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007891 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007892};
7893
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007894OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
7895 FunctionDecl *Fn,
7896 std::string &Description) {
7897 bool isTemplate = false;
7898
7899 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
7900 isTemplate = true;
7901 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7902 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
7903 }
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007904
7905 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007906 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007907 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007908
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007909 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
7910 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
7911
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007912 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
7913 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
7914
7915 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
7916 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
7917
7918 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
7919 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
7920 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007921 }
7922
7923 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7924 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
7925 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007926 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007927 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007928
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007929 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
7930 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
7931
Douglas Gregoref7d78b2012-02-10 08:36:38 +00007932 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
7933 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
7934
7935 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
7936 return oc_method;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007937 }
7938
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007939 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007940}
7941
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007942void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
7943 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
7944 if (!Ctor) return;
7945
7946 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
7947 if (!Ctor) return;
7948
7949 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
7950}
7951
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007952} // end anonymous namespace
7953
7954// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007955void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007956 std::string FnDesc;
7957 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007958 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
7959 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
7960 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
7961 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007962 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007963}
7964
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007965//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
7966// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007967void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007968 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7969
7970 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
7971 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
7972
7973 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7974 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
7975 I != IEnd; ++I) {
7976 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
7977 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007978 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007979 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
7980 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00007981 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007982 }
7983 }
7984}
7985
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007986/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
7987/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
7988/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007989void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
7990 Sema &S,
7991 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7992 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
7993 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
7994 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00007995 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
7996 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
7997 // refactoring here.
7998 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
7999 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
8000 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
8001 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8002 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
8003 break;
8004 ++CandsShown;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008005 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008006 }
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008007 if (I != E)
8008 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008009}
8010
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008011namespace {
8012
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008013void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
8014 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
8015 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008016 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
8017 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8018
8019 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
8020 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
8021 // conversion-slot index.
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008022 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008023 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008024 if (I == 0)
8025 isObjectArgument = true;
8026 else
8027 I--;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008028 }
8029
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008030 std::string FnDesc;
8031 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
8032
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008033 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
8034 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
8035 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008036
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008037 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008038 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008039 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
8040 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
8041 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00008042 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008043
8044 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
8045 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8046 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8047 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008048 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008049 return;
8050 }
8051
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008052 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
8053 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008054 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
8055 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
8056 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8057 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
8058 else {
8059 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
8060 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8061 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8062 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
8063 }
8064
8065 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
8066 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008067 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8068 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8069
8070 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
8071 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
8072 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8073 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8074 << FromTy
8075 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
8076 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008077 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008078 return;
8079 }
8080
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008081 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8b03132011-06-24 00:08:59 +00008082 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008083 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8084 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8085 << FromTy
8086 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
8087 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8088 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8089 return;
8090 }
8091
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00008092 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
8093 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
8094 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8095 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8096 << FromTy
8097 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
8098 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8099 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8100 return;
8101 }
8102
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008103 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
8104 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
8105
8106 if (isObjectArgument) {
8107 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
8108 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8109 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8110 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
8111 } else {
8112 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
8113 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8114 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8115 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
8116 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008117 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008118 return;
8119 }
8120
Sebastian Redlfd2a00a2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00008121 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
8122 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
8123 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
8124 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
8125 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8126 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8127 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8128 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8129 return;
8130 }
8131
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008132 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
8133 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
8134 // the failure.
8135 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
8136 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8137 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
8138 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
8139 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
8140 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8141 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8142 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008143 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008144 return;
8145 }
8146
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008147 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008148 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008149 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8150 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8151 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8152 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8153 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8154 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008155 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008156 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008157 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008158 }
8159 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
8160 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8161 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
8162 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8163 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8164 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8165 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8166 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8167 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008168 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
8169 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008170 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
8171 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
8172 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8173 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
8174 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
8175 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
8176 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
8177 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008178 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
8179 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8180 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8181 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1;
8182 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8183 return;
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008184 }
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008185 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008186
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008187 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008188 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008189 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008190 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8191 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008192 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008193 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008194 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008195 return;
8196 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008197
Fariborz Jahanian909bcb32011-07-20 17:14:09 +00008198 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
8199 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
8200 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8201 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8202 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8203 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
8204 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8205 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8206 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8207 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8208 return;
8209 }
8210 }
8211
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008212 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
8213 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
8214 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008215 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008216 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
8217 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
8218
8219 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer1136ef02012-01-14 21:05:10 +00008220 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
8221 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008222 FDiag << *HI;
8223 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
8224
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008225 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008226}
8227
8228void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8229 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8230 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8231
8232 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8233 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8234
8235 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008236
Douglas Gregor439d3c32011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008237 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
8238 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
8239 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8240 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8241 // Just don't report anything.
8242 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8243 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
8244 return;
8245
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008246 // at least / at most / exactly
8247 unsigned mode, modeCount;
8248 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008249 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8250 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8251 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008252 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregorf5c65ff2011-01-06 22:09:01 +00008253 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008254 mode = 0; // "at least"
8255 else
8256 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8257 modeCount = MinParams;
8258 } else {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008259 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8260 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8261 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008262 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
8263 mode = 1; // "at most"
8264 else
8265 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8266 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
8267 }
8268
8269 std::string Description;
8270 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8271
Richard Smithf7b80562012-05-11 05:16:41 +00008272 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
8273 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
8274 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8275 << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
8276 else
8277 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
8278 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8279 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008280 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008281}
8282
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008283/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8284void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008285 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008286 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
8287
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008288 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008289 NamedDecl *ParamD;
8290 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8291 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8292 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008293 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
8294 case Sema::TDK_Success:
8295 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8296
8297 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008298 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
8299 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8300 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008301 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008302 return;
8303 }
8304
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008305 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8306 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8307 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8308
8309 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
8310
8311 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8312 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008313 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008314 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008315 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008316 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8317
8318 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8319 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8320 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8321 // done on dependent types).
8322 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
8323
8324 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8325 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008326 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008327 return;
8328 }
8329
8330 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008331 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008332 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008333 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008334 which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008335 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008336 which = 1;
8337 else {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008338 which = 2;
8339 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008340
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008341 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008342 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008343 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8344 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008345 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008346 return;
8347 }
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008348
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008349 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008350 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008351 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008352 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008353 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
8354 << ParamD->getDeclName();
8355 else {
8356 int index = 0;
8357 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8358 index = TTP->getIndex();
8359 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8360 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8361 index = NTTP->getIndex();
8362 else
8363 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008364 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008365 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
8366 << (index + 1);
8367 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008368 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008369 return;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008370
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008371 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8372 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8373 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
8374 return;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008375
8376 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8377 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008378 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008379 return;
8380
8381 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008382 // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
8383 llvm::SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
8384 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
8385 Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
8386 TemplateArgString = " ";
8387 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8388 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
8389 }
8390
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008391 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
8392 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
8393 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
8394 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
8395 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
8396 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
8397 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
8398 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
8399 return;
8400 }
8401
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008402 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
8403 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
8404 // formatted message in another diagnostic.
8405 llvm::SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
8406 SourceRange R;
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008407 if (PDiag) {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008408 SFINAEArgString = ": ";
8409 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
8410 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
8411 }
8412
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008413 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008414 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008415 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008416 return;
8417 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008418
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008419 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
8420 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008421 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008422 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8423 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008424 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008425 return;
8426 }
8427}
8428
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008429/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
8430void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8431 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
8432 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
8433
8434 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
8435 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
8436
8437 std::string FnDesc;
8438 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
8439
8440 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
8441 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
8442}
8443
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008444/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
8445/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
8446///
8447/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
8448/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
8449/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
8450/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
8451/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
8452/// overload.
8453///
8454/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
8455/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
8456/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008457void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008458 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008459 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8460
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008461 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008462 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
8463 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008464 std::string FnDesc;
8465 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008466
8467 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +00008468 << FnKind << FnDesc
8469 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008470 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008471 return;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008472 }
8473
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008474 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
8475 if (Cand->Viable) {
8476 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
8477 return;
8478 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008479
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008480 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
8481 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
8482 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
8483 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008484
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008485 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008486 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008487
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008488 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
8489 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00008490 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008491 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008492
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008493 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
8494 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008495 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008496 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
8497 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008498
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008499 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
8500 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
8501 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
8502 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008503 }
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008504
8505 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
8506 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008507 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008508}
8509
8510void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8511 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
8512 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
8513 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
8514 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
8515 bool isLValueReference = false;
8516 bool isRValueReference = false;
8517 bool isPointer = false;
8518 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8519 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
8520 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8521 isLValueReference = true;
8522 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8523 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
8524 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8525 isRValueReference = true;
8526 }
8527 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8528 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8529 isPointer = true;
8530 }
8531 // Desugar down to a function type.
8532 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
8533 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
8534 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
8535 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
8536 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
8537
8538 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
8539 << FnType;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008540 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008541}
8542
8543void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008544 StringRef Opc,
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008545 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8546 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008547 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008548 std::string TypeStr("operator");
8549 TypeStr += Opc;
8550 TypeStr += "(";
8551 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008552 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008553 TypeStr += ")";
8554 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8555 } else {
8556 TypeStr += ", ";
8557 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
8558 TypeStr += ")";
8559 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8560 }
8561}
8562
8563void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8564 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008565 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008566 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
8567 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008568 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
8569 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
8570
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008571 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008572 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008573 }
8574}
8575
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008576SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8577 if (Cand->Function)
8578 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008579 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008580 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
8581 return SourceLocation();
8582}
8583
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008584static unsigned
8585RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth78bf6802011-09-10 00:51:24 +00008586 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008587 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008588 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008589
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +00008590 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008591 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
8592 return 1;
8593
8594 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
8595 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
8596 return 2;
8597
8598 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
8599 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
8600 return 3;
8601
8602 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8603 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8604 return 4;
8605
8606 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
8607 return 5;
8608
8609 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8610 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8611 return 6;
8612 }
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008613 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008614}
8615
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008616struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
8617 Sema &S;
8618 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008619
8620 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
8621 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008622 // Fast-path this check.
8623 if (L == R) return false;
8624
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008625 // Order first by viability.
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008626 if (L->Viable) {
8627 if (!R->Viable) return true;
8628
8629 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
8630 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
8631 // that could exploit it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008632 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
8633 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008634 } else if (R->Viable)
8635 return false;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008636
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008637 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008638
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008639 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
8640 if (!L->Viable) {
8641 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
8642 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8643 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8644 return false;
8645 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8646 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8647 return true;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008648
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008649 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
8650 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
8651 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
8652 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8653 return true;
8654
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008655 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
8656 // comes first.
8657 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8658 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8659 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
8660 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008661 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008662 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
8663 return true;
8664 else
8665 return false;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008666 }
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008667
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008668 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
8669 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008670 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008671
8672 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall3a813372010-02-25 10:46:05 +00008673 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008674 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008675 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8676 L->Conversions[I],
8677 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008678 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8679 leftBetter++;
8680 break;
8681
8682 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8683 leftBetter--;
8684 break;
8685
8686 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8687 break;
8688 }
8689 }
8690 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
8691 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
8692
8693 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8694 return false;
8695
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008696 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
8697 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8698 return true;
8699
8700 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
8701 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedmance1846e2011-10-14 23:10:30 +00008702 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedman1c522f72011-10-14 21:52:24 +00008703 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8704 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008705
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008706 // TODO: others?
8707 }
8708
8709 // Sort everything else by location.
8710 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
8711 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
8712
8713 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
8714 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
8715 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
8716
8717 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008718 }
8719};
8720
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008721/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008722/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008723void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008724 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008725 assert(!Cand->Viable);
8726
8727 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
8728 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
8729
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008730 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
8731 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008732 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
8733 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008734
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008735 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008736 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008737 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008738 while (true) {
8739 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
8740 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008741 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008742 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008743 break;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008744 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008745 }
8746
8747 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
8748 return;
8749
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008750 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
8751 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
8752
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00008753 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008754 // operation somehow.
8755 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008756
8757 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
8758 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
8759
8760 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
8761 QualType ConvType
8762 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8763 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8764 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
8765 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8766 ArgIdx--;
8767 } else if (Cand->Function) {
8768 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8769 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
8770 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
8771 ArgIdx--;
8772 } else {
8773 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
8774 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
8775 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
8776 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008777 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
8778 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008779 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008780 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
8781 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008782 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008783 return;
8784 }
8785
8786 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
8787 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8788 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008789 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008790 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008791 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008792 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008793 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
8794 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008795 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008796 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
8797 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008798 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008799 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008800 else
8801 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
8802 }
8803}
8804
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008805} // end anonymous namespace
8806
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008807/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
8808/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008809/// set.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008810void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
8811 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008812 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008813 StringRef Opc,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008814 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008815 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
8816 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008817 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008818 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
8819 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008820 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008821 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008822 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008823 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008824 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
8825 Cands.push_back(Cand);
8826 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
8827 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008828 }
8829 }
8830
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008831 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008832 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008833
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008834 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008835
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008836 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00008837 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008838 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008839 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8840 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor621b3932008-11-21 02:54:28 +00008841
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008842 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
8843 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
8844 // candidate list.
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00008845 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008846 break;
8847 }
8848 ++CandsShown;
8849
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008850 if (Cand->Function)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008851 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008852 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008853 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008854 else {
8855 assert(Cand->Viable &&
8856 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008857 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
8858 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
8859 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
8860 //
8861 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
8862 // different ambiguities, though.
8863 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008864 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008865 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
8866 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008867
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008868 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008869 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008870 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008871 }
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008872
8873 if (I != E)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008874 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008875}
8876
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008877// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
8878// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
8879// R (A) --> R(A)
8880// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
8881// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
8882// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
8883QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
8884 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
8885 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
8886 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
8887 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8888 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
8889 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8890 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00008891 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008892 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8893 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8894 Ret =
8895 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
8896 return Ret;
8897}
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008898
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008899// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
8900// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
8901class AddressOfFunctionResolver
8902{
8903 Sema& S;
8904 Expr* SourceExpr;
8905 const QualType& TargetType;
8906 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
8907
8908 bool Complain;
8909 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
8910 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008911
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008912 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
8913 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008914
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008915 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
8916 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
8917 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008918 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008919
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008920public:
8921 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
8922 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
8923 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
8924 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
8925 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
8926 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
8927 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
8928 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
8929 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
8930 {
8931 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
8932
8933 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
8934 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8935 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008936 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008937 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00008938
8939 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8940 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
8941 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
8942 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
8943 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
8944 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
8945
8946 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
8947 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
8948 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
8949 return;
8950 }
8951 }
8952
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008953 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
8954 }
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00008955 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008956 return;
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00008957 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008958
8959 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
8960 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008961
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008962 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
8963 // C++ [over.over]p4:
8964 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
8965 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
8966 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
8967 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
8968 else
8969 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
8970 }
8971 }
8972 }
8973
8974private:
8975 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
8976 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
8977 }
8978
8979 // [ToType] [Return]
8980
8981 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
8982 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
8983 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
8984 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
8985 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
8986 }
8987
8988 // return true if any matching specializations were found
8989 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
8990 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
8991 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
8992 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
8993 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
8994 // static when converting to member pointer.
8995 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8996 return false;
8997 }
8998 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8999 return false;
9000
9001 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9002 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9003 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9004 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9005 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9006 // overloaded functions considered.
9007 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009008 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009009 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
9010 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
9011 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
9012 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
9013 Info)) {
9014 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9015 (void)Result;
9016 return false;
9017 }
9018
9019 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
9020 // This function template specicalization works.
9021 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
9022 assert(TargetFunctionType
9023 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
9024 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
9025 return true;
9026 }
9027
9028 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
9029 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009030 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009031 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
9032 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009033 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9034 return false;
9035 }
9036 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9037 return false;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009038
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009039 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009040 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009041 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
9042 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
9043 return false;
9044
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00009045 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009046 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
9047 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00009048 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
9049 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009050 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
9051 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009052 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009053 return true;
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009054 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009055 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009056
9057 return false;
9058 }
9059
9060 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
9061 bool Ret = false;
9062
9063 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
9064 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
9065 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9066 return false;
9067
9068 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9069 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9070 I != E; ++I) {
9071 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
9072 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9073
9074 // C++ [over.over]p3:
9075 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
9076 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
9077 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
9078 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
9079 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
9080 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9081 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
9082 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
9083 Ret = true;
9084 }
9085 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
9086 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
9087 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
9088 Ret = true;
9089 }
9090 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
9091 return Ret;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009092 }
9093
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009094 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00009095 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
9096 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
9097 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
9098 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
9099 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
9100
9101 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
9102 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
9103 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
9104 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009105
9106 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
9107 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
9108 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009109
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009110 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009111 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
9112 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
9113 S.PDiag(),
9114 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9115 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
9116 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
9117 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009118 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009119
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009120 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
9121 // Make it the first and only element
9122 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
9123 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
9124 Matches.resize(1);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009125 }
9126 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009127
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009128 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
9129 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
9130 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
9131 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
9132 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
9133 ++I;
9134 else {
9135 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
9136 Matches.set_size(N);
9137 }
9138 }
9139 }
9140
9141public:
9142 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
9143 assert(Matches.empty());
9144 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
9145 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
9146 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009147 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009148 }
9149
9150 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9151 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
9152 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
9153 }
9154
9155 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9156 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
9157 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
9158 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
9159 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
9160 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9161 }
9162
9163 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
9164 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
9165 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
9166 }
9167
9168 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
9169 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
9170 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9171 << OvlExpr->getName()
9172 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009173 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009174 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009175
9176 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
9177
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009178 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
9179
9180 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
9181 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9182 return Matches[0].second;
9183 }
9184
9185 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
9186 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9187 return &Matches[0].first;
9188 }
9189};
9190
9191/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
9192/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
9193/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
9194/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
9195///
9196/// @code
9197/// int f(double);
9198/// int f(int);
9199///
9200/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
9201/// @endcode
9202///
9203/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
9204/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
9205/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
9206FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009207Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
9208 QualType TargetType,
9209 bool Complain,
9210 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
9211 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009212 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009213
9214 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
9215 Complain);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009216 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
9217 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009218 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009219 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9220 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
9221 else
9222 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
9223 }
9224 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
9225 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
9226 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
9227 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
9228 assert(Fn);
9229 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +00009230 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009231 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redl07ab2022009-10-17 21:12:09 +00009232 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009233
9234 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
9235 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009236 return Fn;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009237}
9238
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009239/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009240/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
9241///
9242/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
9243/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009244/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009245/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009246FunctionDecl *
9247Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
9248 bool Complain,
9249 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009250 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9251 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
9252 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009253 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9254 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
9255 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009256
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009257 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009258 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009259 return 0;
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00009260
9261 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009262 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009263
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009264 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
9265 // whose type matches exactly.
9266 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009267 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
9268 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009269 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
9270 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009271 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
9272 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
9273 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009274 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregor66a8c9a2010-07-14 23:20:53 +00009275 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9276 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009277
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009278 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9279 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9280 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9281 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9282 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9283 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009284 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009285 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009286 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
9287 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9288 Specialization, Info)) {
9289 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9290 (void)Result;
9291 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009292 }
9293
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009294 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
9295
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009296 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009297 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009298 if (Complain) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009299 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9300 << ovl->getName();
9301 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009302 }
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009303 return 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009304 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009305
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009306 Matched = Specialization;
9307 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009308 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009309
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009310 return Matched;
9311}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009312
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009313
9314
9315
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009316// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
9317// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
9318//
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009319// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009320//
9321// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
9322// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
9323// returns true if 'complain' is set.
9324bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9325 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
9326 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009327 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009328 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009329 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009330
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009331 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009332
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009333 DeclAccessPair found;
9334 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
9335 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9336 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00009337 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009338 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9339 return true;
9340 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009341
9342 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
9343 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
9344 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
9345 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
9346 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
9347 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
9348 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009349 if (!complain) return false;
9350
9351 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
9352 diag::err_bound_member_function)
9353 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
9354
9355 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
9356 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
9357 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
9358 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
9359 // the static candidates were rejected.
9360 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9361 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009362 }
Douglas Gregordb2eae62011-03-16 19:16:25 +00009363
Sylvestre Ledru43e3dee2012-07-31 06:56:50 +00009364 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009365 SingleFunctionExpression =
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009366 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn));
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009367
9368 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009369 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009370 SingleFunctionExpression =
9371 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009372 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
9373 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9374 return true;
9375 }
9376 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009377 }
9378
9379 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
9380 if (complain) {
9381 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
9382 << ovl.Expression->getName()
9383 << DestTypeForComplaining
9384 << OpRangeForComplaining
9385 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009386 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
9387
9388 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9389 return true;
9390 }
9391
9392 return false;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009393 }
9394
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009395 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
9396 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009397}
9398
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009399/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
9400static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009401 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009402 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009403 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009404 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009405 bool PartialOverloading,
9406 bool KnownValid) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009407 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009408 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
9409 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
9410
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009411 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009412 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9413 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
9414 return;
9415 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009416 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
9417 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009418 return;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009419 }
9420
9421 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
9422 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009423 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009424 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009425 return;
9426 }
9427
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009428 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009429}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009430
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009431/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
9432/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009433void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009434 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009435 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
9436 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009437
9438#ifndef NDEBUG
9439 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
9440 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009441 //
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009442 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
9443 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
9444 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
9445 //
9446 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
9447 //
9448 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009449 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009450 //
9451 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
9452 // template
9453 //
9454 // then Y is empty.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009455
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009456 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9457 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9458 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9459 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
9460 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
9461 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
9462 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009463 }
9464 }
9465#endif
9466
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009467 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
9468 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009469 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009470 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9471 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9472 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9473 }
9474
9475 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9476 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009477 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
9478 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
9479 /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009480
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009481 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009482 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00009483 ULE->getExprLoc(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009484 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00009485 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009486}
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009487
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009488/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
9489/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
9490/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
9491/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
9492///
9493/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9494static bool
9495DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
9496 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
9497 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009498 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009499 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
9500 return false;
9501
9502 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
Nick Lewycky5a7120c2012-03-14 20:41:00 +00009503 if (DC->isTransparentContext())
9504 continue;
9505
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009506 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
9507
9508 if (!R.empty()) {
9509 R.suppressDiagnostics();
9510
9511 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
9512 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
9513 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
9514 R.clear();
9515 return false;
9516 }
9517
9518 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
9519 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
9520 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009521 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009522 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009523
9524 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009525 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009526 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
9527 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009528 R.clear();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009529 return false;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009530 }
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009531
9532 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
9533 // declaring the function there instead.
9534 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
9535 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
John McCall42f48fb2012-08-24 20:38:34 +00009536 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009537 AssociatedNamespaces,
9538 AssociatedClasses);
Nick Lewyckyd05df512012-11-13 00:08:34 +00009539 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009540 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Nick Lewyckyd05df512012-11-13 00:08:34 +00009541 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
9542 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
9543 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
9544 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
9545 NamespaceDecl *Assoc = cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
9546 if ((!Std || !Std->Encloses(Assoc)) &&
9547 Assoc->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") == std::string::npos)
9548 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(Assoc);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009549 }
9550
9551 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9552 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009553 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009554 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9555 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9556 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009557 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009558 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9559 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009560 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009561 } else {
9562 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
9563 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
9564 // a localized representation of a list of items.
9565 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9566 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9567 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
9568 }
9569
9570 // Try to recover by calling this function.
9571 return true;
9572 }
9573
9574 R.clear();
9575 }
9576
9577 return false;
9578}
9579
9580/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
9581/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
9582/// was defined.
9583///
9584/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9585static bool
9586DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9587 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009588 llvm::ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009589 DeclarationName OpName =
9590 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9591 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
9592 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009593 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009594}
9595
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009596namespace {
9597// Callback to limit the allowed keywords and to only accept typo corrections
9598// that are keywords or whose decls refer to functions (or template functions)
9599// that accept the given number of arguments.
9600class RecoveryCallCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9601 public:
9602 RecoveryCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, unsigned NumArgs, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs)
9603 : NumArgs(NumArgs), HasExplicitTemplateArgs(HasExplicitTemplateArgs) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009604 WantTypeSpecifiers = SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009605 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9606 }
9607
9608 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9609 if (!candidate.getCorrectionDecl())
9610 return candidate.isKeyword();
9611
9612 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator DI = candidate.begin(),
9613 DIEnd = candidate.end(); DI != DIEnd; ++DI) {
9614 FunctionDecl *FD = 0;
9615 NamedDecl *ND = (*DI)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9616 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND))
9617 FD = FTD->getTemplatedDecl();
9618 if (!HasExplicitTemplateArgs && !FD) {
9619 if (!(FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND)) && isa<ValueDecl>(ND)) {
9620 // If the Decl is neither a function nor a template function,
9621 // determine if it is a pointer or reference to a function. If so,
9622 // check against the number of arguments expected for the pointee.
9623 QualType ValType = cast<ValueDecl>(ND)->getType();
9624 if (ValType->isAnyPointerType() || ValType->isReferenceType())
9625 ValType = ValType->getPointeeType();
9626 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = ValType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9627 if (FPT->getNumArgs() == NumArgs)
9628 return true;
9629 }
9630 }
9631 if (FD && FD->getNumParams() >= NumArgs &&
9632 FD->getMinRequiredArguments() <= NumArgs)
9633 return true;
9634 }
9635 return false;
9636 }
9637
9638 private:
9639 unsigned NumArgs;
9640 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs;
9641};
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009642
9643// Callback that effectively disabled typo correction
9644class NoTypoCorrectionCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9645 public:
9646 NoTypoCorrectionCCC() {
9647 WantTypeSpecifiers = false;
9648 WantExpressionKeywords = false;
9649 WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
9650 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9651 }
9652
9653 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9654 return false;
9655 }
9656};
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009657
9658class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
9659 Sema &SemaRef;
9660public:
9661 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
9662 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
9663 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
9664 }
9665
9666 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
9667 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
9668 }
9669};
9670
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009671}
9672
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009673/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
9674///
9675/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009676static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009677BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009678 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9679 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009680 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009681 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009682 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009683 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
9684 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
9685 //
9686 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
9687 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
9688 //
9689 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
9690 return ExprError();
9691 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009692
9693 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009694 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009695 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009696
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009697 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009698 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009699 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9700 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9701 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9702 }
9703
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009704 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
9705 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009706 RecoveryCallCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(), ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0);
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009707 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
9708 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
9709 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
9710 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009711 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009712 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) &&
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009713 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009714 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009715 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009716 return ExprError();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009717
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009718 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
9719
9720 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
9721 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009722 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009723 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009724 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
9725 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009726 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009727 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009728 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009729 else
9730 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
9731
9732 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009733 return ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009734
9735 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009736 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009737 // end up here.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009738 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009739 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
9740 RParenLoc);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009741}
Douglas Gregord7a95972010-06-08 17:35:15 +00009742
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009743/// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
9744/// the given function.
9745/// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
9746bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9747 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9748 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9749 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9750 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
9751 ExprResult *Result) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009752#ifndef NDEBUG
9753 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9754 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
9755 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
9756
9757 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
9758 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
9759 FunctionDecl *F;
9760 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
9761 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
9762 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009763 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009764
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009765 // We don't perform ADL in C.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009766 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00009767 }
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009768#endif
9769
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009770 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009771 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts)) {
9772 *Result = ExprError();
9773 return true;
9774 }
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00009775
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009776 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
9777 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009778 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009779 *CandidateSet);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009780
9781 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009782 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
9783 // out if it fails.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009784 if (CandidateSet->empty()) {
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009785 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
9786 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009787 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009788 // classes.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009789 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetc8ff9152011-11-25 01:10:54 +00009790 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +00009791 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
9792 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
9793 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
9794 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009795 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009796 *Result = Owned(CE);
9797 return true;
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009798 }
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009799 return false;
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009800 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009801
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009802 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009803 return false;
9804}
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009805
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009806/// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
9807/// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
9808/// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
9809static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9810 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9811 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9812 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9813 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9814 Expr *ExecConfig,
9815 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
9816 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
9817 OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
9818 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
9819 if (CandidateSet->empty())
9820 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
9821 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
9822 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
9823 AllowTypoCorrection);
9824
9825 switch (OverloadResult) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009826 case OR_Success: {
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009827 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
9828 SemaRef.MarkFunctionReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
9829 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
9830 SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc());
9831 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9832 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9833 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009834 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009835
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009836 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9837 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
9838 // have meant to call.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009839 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009840 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
9841 RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009842 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
9843 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009844 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
9845 return Recovery;
9846
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009847 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009848 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009849 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009850 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates,
9851 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009852 break;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009853 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009854
9855 case OR_Ambiguous:
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009856 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009857 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009858 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates,
9859 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009860 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009861
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009862 case OR_Deleted: {
9863 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
9864 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
9865 << ULE->getName()
9866 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
9867 << Fn->getSourceRange();
9868 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates,
9869 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0d579b62011-11-04 15:58:13 +00009870
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009871 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
9872 // the call in the AST.
9873 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
9874 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9875 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9876 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
9877 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009878 }
9879
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00009880 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009881 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009882}
9883
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009884/// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
9885/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
9886/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
9887/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
9888/// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
9889/// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
9890ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9891 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9892 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9893 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9894 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9895 Expr *ExecConfig,
9896 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
9897 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
9898 ExprResult result;
9899
9900 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, NumArgs, LParenLoc,
9901 &CandidateSet, &result))
9902 return result;
9903
9904 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
9905 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
9906 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
9907
9908 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9909 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
9910 &Best, OverloadResult,
9911 AllowTypoCorrection);
9912}
9913
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009914static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00009915 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
9916 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
9917}
9918
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009919/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
9920/// operator.
9921///
9922/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
9923///
9924/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
9925/// operator.
9926///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00009927/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009928/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
9929/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
9930/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
9931/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
9932/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
9933///
James Dennett8da16872012-06-22 10:32:46 +00009934/// \param Input The input argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009935ExprResult
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009936Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
9937 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009938 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009939 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009940
9941 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
9942 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
9943 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009944 // TODO: provide better source location info.
9945 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009946
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009947 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
9948 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009949
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009950 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
9951 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009952
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009953 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
9954 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
9955 // post-decrement.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009956 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009957 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00009958 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
9959 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009960 NumArgs = 2;
9961 }
9962
9963 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009964 if (Fns.empty())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009965 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009966 Opc,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009967 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009968 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +00009969 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009970
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009971 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009972 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00009973 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009974 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00009975 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
9976 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009977 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +00009978 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009979 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009980 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +00009981 OpLoc, false));
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009982 }
9983
9984 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009985 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009986
9987 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009988 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
9989 false);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00009990
9991 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
9992 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
9993
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009994 // Add candidates from ADL.
9995 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009996 OpLoc, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009997 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
9998 CandidateSet);
9999
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010000 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +000010001 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010002
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010003 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10004
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010005 // Perform overload resolution.
10006 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010007 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010008 case OR_Success: {
10009 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10010 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010011
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010012 if (FnDecl) {
10013 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10014 // operator.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010015
Eli Friedman5f2987c2012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010016 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +000010017
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010018 // Convert the arguments.
10019 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010020 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010021
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010022 ExprResult InputRes =
10023 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
10024 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10025 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010026 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010027 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010028 } else {
10029 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010030 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010031 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010032 Context,
Douglas Gregorbaecfed2009-12-23 00:02:00 +000010033 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010034 SourceLocation(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010035 Input);
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010036 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010037 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010038 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010039 }
10040
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010041 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
10042
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010043 // Determine the result type.
10044 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10045 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10046 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010047
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010048 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010049 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010050 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010051 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10052 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010053
Eli Friedman4c3b8962009-11-18 03:58:17 +000010054 Args[0] = Input;
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010055 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010056 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010057 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010058 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010059
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010060 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson26a2a072009-10-13 21:19:37 +000010061 FnDecl))
10062 return ExprError();
10063
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010064 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010065 } else {
10066 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10067 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10068 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010069 ExprResult InputRes =
10070 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10071 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10072 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
10073 return ExprError();
10074 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010075 break;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010076 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010077 }
10078
10079 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010080 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10081 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10082 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010083 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc,
10084 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010085 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10086 return ExprError();
10087
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010088 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
10089 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
10090 break;
10091
10092 case OR_Ambiguous:
10093 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10094 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10095 << Input->getType()
10096 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010097 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
10098 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010099 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
10100 return ExprError();
10101
10102 case OR_Deleted:
10103 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10104 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10105 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10106 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10107 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010108 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10109 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010110 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010111 return ExprError();
10112 }
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010113
10114 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
10115 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
10116 // build a built-in operation.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010117 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010118}
10119
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010120/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10121/// operator.
10122///
10123/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
10124///
10125/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10126/// operator.
10127///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010128/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010129/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10130/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10131/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10132/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10133/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
10134///
10135/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
10136/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010137ExprResult
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010138Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010139 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010140 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010141 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010142 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010143 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010144
10145 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
10146 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10147 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10148
10149 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10150 // expression.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010151 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010152 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010153 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010154 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010155 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010156 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010157 Context.DependentTy,
10158 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010159 OpLoc,
10160 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010161
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010162 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
10163 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010164 VK_LValue,
10165 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010166 Context.DependentTy,
10167 Context.DependentTy,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010168 OpLoc,
10169 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010170 }
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010171
10172 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010173 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010174 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
10175 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010176 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010177 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
10178 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
10179 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010180 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010181 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args,
10182 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10183 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010184 }
10185
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010186 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
10187 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10188 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010189
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +000010190 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
10191 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
10192 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010193 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10194 return ExprError();
10195
Sebastian Redl275c2b42009-11-18 23:10:33 +000010196 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
10197 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
10198 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
10199 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
10200 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
10201 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010202 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010203 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010204
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010205 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
10206 // create a built-in binary operator.
10207 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
10208 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
10209
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010210 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010211 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010212
10213 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010214 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010215
10216 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10217 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10218
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010219 // Add candidates from ADL.
10220 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010221 OpLoc, Args,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010222 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
10223 CandidateSet);
10224
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010225 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +000010226 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010227
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010228 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10229
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010230 // Perform overload resolution.
10231 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010232 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +000010233 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010234 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10235 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10236
10237 if (FnDecl) {
10238 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10239 // operator.
10240
Eli Friedman5f2987c2012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010241 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +000010242
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010243 // Convert the arguments.
10244 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010245 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010246 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010247
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010248 ExprResult Arg1 =
10249 PerformCopyInitialization(
10250 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10251 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10252 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010253 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010254 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010255
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010256 ExprResult Arg0 =
10257 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10258 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10259 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010260 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010261 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010262 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010263 } else {
10264 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010265 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
10266 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10267 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10268 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010269 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010270 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010271
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010272 ExprResult Arg1 =
10273 PerformCopyInitialization(
10274 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10275 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
10276 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010277 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
10278 return ExprError();
10279 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
10280 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010281 }
10282
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010283 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
10284
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010285 // Determine the result type.
10286 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10287 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10288 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010289
10290 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010291 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
10292 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010293 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10294 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010295
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010296 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010297 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010298 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
10299 FPFeatures.fp_contract);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010300
10301 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010302 FnDecl))
10303 return ExprError();
10304
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010305 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010306 } else {
10307 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10308 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10309 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010310 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10311 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10312 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10313 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010314 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010315 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010316
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010317 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10318 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10319 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10320 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10321 return ExprError();
10322 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010323 break;
10324 }
10325 }
10326
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010327 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10328 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
10329 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
10330 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
10331 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010332 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010333 break;
10334
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010335 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
10336 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
10337 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010338 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010339 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010340 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010341 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
10342 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010343 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010344 } else {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010345 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10346 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10347 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010348 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010349 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10350 return ExprError();
10351
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010352 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
10353 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
10354 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010355 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010356 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010357 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
10358 if (Result.isInvalid())
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010359 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010360 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000010361 return Result;
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010362 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010363
10364 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010365 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010366 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010367 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010368 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010369 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010370 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010371 return ExprError();
10372
10373 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010374 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
10375 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
10376 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
10377 << getSpecialMember(Method)
10378 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10379 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function);
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +000010380
10381 if (getSpecialMember(Method) != CXXInvalid) {
10382 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
10383 // explain why it's deleted.
10384 NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010385 return ExprError();
10386 }
10387 } else {
10388 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10389 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10390 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10391 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10392 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10393 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010394 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010395 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010396 return ExprError();
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +000010397 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010398
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010399 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010400 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010401}
10402
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010403ExprResult
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010404Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
10405 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010406 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
10407 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010408 DeclarationName OpName =
10409 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
10410
10411 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10412 // expression.
10413 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
10414
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010415 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010416 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
10417 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10418 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010419 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010420 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010421 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010422 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
10423 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
10424 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010425 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010426
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010427 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010428 Args,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010429 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010430 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010431 RLoc, false));
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010432 }
10433
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010434 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
10435 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10436 return ExprError();
10437 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10438 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010439
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010440 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010441 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010442
10443 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
10444
10445 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10446 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10447
10448 // Add builtin operator candidates.
10449 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10450
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010451 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10452
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010453 // Perform overload resolution.
10454 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010455 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010456 case OR_Success: {
10457 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10458 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10459
10460 if (FnDecl) {
10461 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10462 // operator.
10463
Eli Friedman5f2987c2012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010464 MarkFunctionReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl);
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +000010465
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010466 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010467 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010468
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010469 // Convert the arguments.
10470 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010471 ExprResult Arg0 =
10472 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10473 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10474 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010475 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010476 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010477
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010478 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010479 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010480 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010481 Context,
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010482 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010483 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010484 Owned(Args[1]));
10485 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
10486 return ExprError();
10487
10488 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
10489
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010490 // Determine the result type
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010491 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10492 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10493 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010494
10495 // Build the actual expression node.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010496 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10497 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010498 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
10499 HadMultipleCandidates,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010500 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
10501 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010502 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10503 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010504
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010505 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
10506 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010507 FnExpr.take(), Args,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010508 ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
10509 false);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010510
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010511 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010512 FnDecl))
10513 return ExprError();
10514
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010515 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010516 } else {
10517 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10518 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10519 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010520 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10521 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10522 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10523 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010524 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010525 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
10526
10527 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10528 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10529 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10530 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10531 return ExprError();
10532 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010533
10534 break;
10535 }
10536 }
10537
10538 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010539 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10540 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10541 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
10542 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10543 else
10544 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
10545 << Args[0]->getType()
10546 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010547 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010548 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010549 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010550 }
10551
10552 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010553 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010554 << "[]"
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010555 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
10556 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010557 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010558 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010559 return ExprError();
10560
10561 case OR_Deleted:
10562 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10563 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010564 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010565 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010566 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010567 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010568 return ExprError();
10569 }
10570
10571 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010572 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010573}
10574
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010575/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
10576/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
10577/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
10578/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
10579/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010580/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
10581/// member function.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010582ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010583Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
10584 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010585 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010586 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
10587 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10588
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010589 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
10590 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010591 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010592
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010593 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
10594 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10595 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
10596 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
10597
10598 QualType fnType =
10599 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10600
10601 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10602 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
10603 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
10604
10605 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
10606 // member function we're calling.
10607 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
10608
10609 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
10610 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
10611 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10612 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
10613
10614 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
10615 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
10616 difference.removeAddressSpace();
10617 if (difference) {
10618 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
10619 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
10620 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
10621 << qualsString
10622 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
10623 }
10624
10625 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010626 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE,
10627 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010628 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
10629
10630 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010631 op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010632 call, 0))
10633 return ExprError();
10634
10635 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
10636 return ExprError();
10637
10638 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
10639 }
10640
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010641 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10642 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10643 return ExprError();
10644
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010645 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010646 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCallbb6fb462010-04-08 00:13:37 +000010647 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010648 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010649 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10650 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010651 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010652 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010653 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010654 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010655 } else {
10656 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010657 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010658
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010659 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010660 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
10661 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
10662 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010663
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010664 // Add overload candidates
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010665 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010666
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010667 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10668 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10669 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10670 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10671 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10672 }
10673
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010674 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
10675 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10676
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010677 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
10678 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
10679 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
10680 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
10681
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010682
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010683 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010684 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010685 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
10686 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet);
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010687 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010688 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
10689 // non-template member function.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010690 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010691 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010692
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010693 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010694 ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010695 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010696 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010697 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010698 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010699 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010700 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010701 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
10702 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010703 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010704 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010705 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010706
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010707 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
10708
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010709 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10710
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010711 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010712 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +000010713 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010714 case OR_Success:
10715 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Eli Friedman5f2987c2012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010716 MarkFunctionReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010717 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010718 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010719 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010720 break;
10721
10722 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010723 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010724 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010725 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010726 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10727 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010728 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010729 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010730
10731 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010732 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010733 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010734 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10735 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010736 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010737 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010738
10739 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010740 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010741 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010742 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010743 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010744 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010745 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10746 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010747 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010748 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010749 }
10750
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010751 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010752
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010753 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
10754 // non-member call based on that function.
10755 if (Method->isStatic()) {
10756 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
10757 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
10758 }
10759
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010760 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010761 }
10762
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010763 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
10764 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
10765 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10766
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010767 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010768 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010769 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE,
10770 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010771 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010772
Anders Carlssoneed3e692009-10-10 00:06:20 +000010773 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010774 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010775 TheCall, Method))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010776 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010777
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010778 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010779 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
10780 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010781 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
10782 ExprResult ObjectArg =
10783 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
10784 FoundDecl, Method);
10785 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
10786 return ExprError();
10787 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
10788 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010789
10790 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010791 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
10792 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010793 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010794 RParenLoc))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010795 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010796
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000010797 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
10798
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000010799 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010800 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson6f680272009-08-16 03:42:12 +000010801
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010802 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
10803 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
10804 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
10805 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
10806
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010807 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010808 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
10809 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
10810 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
10811 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
10812
10813 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010814 }
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010815 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010816 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010817}
10818
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010819/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
10820/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
10821/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
10822/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010823ExprResult
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010824Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregor5c37de72008-12-06 00:22:45 +000010825 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010826 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010827 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010828 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
10829 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010830 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010831
10832 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10833 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10834 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010835
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010836 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
10837 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010838
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010839 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
10840 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman33a31382009-08-05 19:21:58 +000010841 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010842 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
10843 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
10844 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
10845 // (E).operator().
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010846 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor44b43212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000010847 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010848
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010849 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000010850 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010851 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010852
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000010853 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
10854 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
10855 R.suppressDiagnostics();
10856
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010857 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010858 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010859 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
10860 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +000010861 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010862 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010863
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010864 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010865 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
10866 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010867 //
10868 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
10869 //
10870 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
10871 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregora967a6f2008-11-20 13:33:37 +000010872 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
10873 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
10874 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
10875 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010876 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
10877 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
10878 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
10879 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
10880 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +000010881 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor90073282010-01-11 19:36:35 +000010882 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +000010883 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010884 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010885 NamedDecl *D = *I;
10886 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
10887 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
10888 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010889
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010890 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
10891 // surrogates.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010892 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000010893 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +000010894
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010895 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010896 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
10897 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
10898 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
10899 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
10900 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
10901 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010902
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010903 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
10904 {
10905 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010906 Object.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
10907 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000010908 }
10909 }
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010910 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010911
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010912 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10913
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010914 // Perform overload resolution.
10915 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010916 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010917 Best)) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010918 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010919 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
10920 // below.
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010921 break;
10922
10923 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010924 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010925 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010926 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
10927 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010928 else
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010929 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010930 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010931 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010932 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10933 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010934 break;
10935
10936 case OR_Ambiguous:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010937 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010938 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010939 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010940 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
10941 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010942 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010943
10944 case OR_Deleted:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010945 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010946 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
10947 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010948 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010949 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010950 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010951 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10952 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010953 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010954 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010955
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +000010956 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010957 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010958
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010959 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10960
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010961 if (Best->Function == 0) {
10962 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
10963 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010964 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010965 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
10966 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
10967
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010968 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010969 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000010970
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010971 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
10972 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
10973 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010974
Fariborz Jahaniand8307b12009-09-28 18:35:46 +000010975 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanianb7400232009-09-28 23:23:40 +000010976 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010977 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
10978 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000010979 if (Call.isInvalid())
10980 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +000010981 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
10982 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
10983 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
10984 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010985
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000010986 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010987 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010988 }
10989
Eli Friedman5f2987c2012-02-02 03:46:19 +000010990 MarkFunctionReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010991 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010992 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000010993
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010994 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
10995 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
10996 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
10997 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000010998
10999 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
Nico Weber1a52a4d2012-11-09 08:38:04 +000011000 if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011001 return ExprError();
11002
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011003 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11004 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011005
11006 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
11007 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
11008
11009 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
11010 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
11011 // list).
11012 Expr **MethodArgs;
11013 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
11014 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11015 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
11016 } else {
11017 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
11018 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011019 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011020 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
11021 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011022
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011023 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
11024 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
11025 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011026 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011027 HadMultipleCandidates,
11028 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11029 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011030 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
11031 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011032
11033 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
11034 // owned.
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011035 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11036 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11037 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11038
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011039 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011040 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011041 llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs, NumArgs+1),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011042 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011043 delete [] MethodArgs;
11044
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011045 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson07d68f12009-10-13 21:49:31 +000011046 Method))
11047 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011048
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011049 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
11050 // slots in the call for them.
11051 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +000011052 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011053 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
11054 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11055
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011056 bool IsError = false;
11057
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011058 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011059 ExprResult ObjRes =
11060 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
11061 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11062 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
11063 IsError = true;
11064 else
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000011065 Object = ObjRes;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011066 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011067
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011068 // Check the argument types.
11069 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011070 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011071 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011072 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011073
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011074 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011075
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011076 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011077 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000011078 Context,
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011079 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011080 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011081
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011082 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
11083 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011084 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011085 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011086 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
11087 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
11088 IsError = true;
11089 break;
11090 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011091
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011092 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011093 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011094
11095 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
11096 }
11097
11098 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
11099 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
11100 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Aaron Ballman4914c282012-07-20 20:40:35 +000011101 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i < NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011102 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
11103 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
11104 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011105 }
11106 }
11107
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011108 if (IsError) return true;
11109
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011110 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
11111
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011112 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +000011113 return true;
11114
John McCall182f7092010-08-24 06:09:16 +000011115 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011116}
11117
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011118/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011119/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011120/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011121ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011122Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011123 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11124 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011125
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011126 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
11127 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011128
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011129 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
11130
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011131 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
11132 //
11133 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
11134 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
11135 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
11136 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011137 DeclarationName OpName =
11138 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011139 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +000011140 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011141
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011142 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011143 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
Eli Friedmanf43fb722009-11-18 01:28:03 +000011144 return ExprError();
11145
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011146 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11147 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
11148 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlssone30572a2009-09-10 23:18:36 +000011149
11150 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011151 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011152 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
11153 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011154 }
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011155
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011156 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11157
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011158 // Perform overload resolution.
11159 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011160 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011161 case OR_Success:
11162 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
11163 break;
11164
11165 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11166 if (CandidateSet.empty())
11167 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011168 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011169 else
11170 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011171 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011172 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011173 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011174
11175 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011176 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
11177 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011178 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011179 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011180
11181 case OR_Deleted:
11182 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11183 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011184 << "->"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011185 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011186 << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011187 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011188 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011189 }
11190
Eli Friedman5f2987c2012-02-02 03:46:19 +000011191 MarkFunctionReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011192 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000011193 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011194
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011195 // Convert the object parameter.
11196 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011197 ExprResult BaseResult =
11198 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
11199 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11200 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011201 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011202 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregorfc195ef2008-11-21 03:04:22 +000011203
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011204 // Build the operator call.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011205 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011206 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011207 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11208 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011209
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011210 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11211 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11212 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011213 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011214 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011215 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011216
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011217 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011218 Method))
11219 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmand5931902011-04-04 01:18:25 +000011220
11221 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011222}
11223
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011224/// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
11225/// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
11226ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
11227 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
11228 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
11229 SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
11230 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
11231 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011232
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011233 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc);
11234 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true,
11235 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011236
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011237 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11238
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011239 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
11240 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
11241 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11242 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
11243 case OR_Success:
11244 case OR_Deleted:
11245 break;
11246
11247 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11248 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
11249 << R.getLookupName();
11250 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11251 return ExprError();
11252
11253 case OR_Ambiguous:
11254 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
11255 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
11256 return ExprError();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011257 }
11258
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011259 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
11260 MarkFunctionReferenced(UDSuffixLoc, FD);
11261 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UDSuffixLoc);
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011262
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011263 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, HadMultipleCandidates,
11264 SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
11265 SuffixInfo.getInfo());
11266 if (Fn.isInvalid())
11267 return true;
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011268
11269 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
11270 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011271 Expr *ConvArgs[2];
11272 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
11273 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
11274 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
11275 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
11276 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11277 return true;
11278 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.take();
11279 }
11280
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011281 QualType ResultTy = FD->getResultType();
11282 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11283 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11284
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011285 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011286 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.take(),
11287 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011288 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
11289
11290 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getResultType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
11291 return ExprError();
11292
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011293 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, NULL))
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011294 return ExprError();
11295
11296 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
11297}
11298
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011299/// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
11300/// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
11301/// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
11302/// dependent lookup.
11303/// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
11304/// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
11305/// is returned.
11306Sema::ForRangeStatus
11307Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
11308 SourceLocation RangeLoc, VarDecl *Decl,
11309 BeginEndFunction BEF,
11310 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
11311 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
11312 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
11313 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
11314 CandidateSet->clear();
11315 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
11316 ExprResult MemberRef =
11317 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
11318 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
11319 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
11320 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/0,
11321 MemberLookup,
11322 /*TemplateArgs=*/0);
11323 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
11324 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11325 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11326 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11327 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11328 }
11329 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, MultiExprArg(), Loc, 0);
11330 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
11331 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11332 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11333 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11334 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11335 }
11336 } else {
11337 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011338 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
11339 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/0,
11340 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
11341 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +000011342 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011343
11344 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, &Range, 1, Loc,
11345 CandidateSet, CallExpr);
11346 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
11347 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11348 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11349 }
11350 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11351 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
11352 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
11353
11354 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
11355 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11356 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11357 }
11358 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, &Range, 1,
11359 Loc, 0, CandidateSet, &Best,
11360 OverloadResult,
11361 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
11362 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
11363 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11364 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11365 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11366 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11367 }
11368 }
11369 return FRS_Success;
11370}
11371
11372
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011373/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
11374/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
11375/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
11376/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlsson96ad5332009-10-21 17:16:23 +000011377/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +000011378Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011379 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011380 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011381 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
11382 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011383 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011384 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011385
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011386 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011387 }
11388
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011389 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011390 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
11391 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011392 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011393 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor097bfb12009-10-23 22:18:25 +000011394 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011395 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011396 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011397 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011398
11399 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011400 ICE->getCastKind(),
11401 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000011402 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011403 }
11404
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011405 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011406 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011407 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011408 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
11409 if (Method->isStatic()) {
11410 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
11411 // from non-member functions.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011412 } else {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011413 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
11414 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
11415 // or template.
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011416 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11417 Found, Fn);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011418 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011419 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011420
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011421 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
11422 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
11423 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
11424 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
11425
11426 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
11427 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
11428 // appropriate pointer to member type.
11429 QualType ClassType
11430 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
11431 QualType MemPtrType
11432 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
11433
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011434 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
11435 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
11436 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011437 }
11438 }
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011439 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11440 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011441 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011442 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011443
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011444 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011445 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011446 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011447 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011448 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011449
11450 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011451 // FIXME: avoid copy.
11452 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011453 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011454 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11455 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011456 }
11457
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011458 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11459 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011460 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011461 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011462 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011463 ULE->getNameLoc(),
11464 Fn->getType(),
11465 VK_LValue,
11466 Found.getDecl(),
11467 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011468 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011469 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
11470 return DRE;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011471 }
11472
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011473 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011474 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011475 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
11476 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11477 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11478 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11479 }
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011480
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011481 Expr *Base;
11482
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011483 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
11484 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011485 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
11486 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011487 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11488 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011489 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011490 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011491 /*enclosing*/ false,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011492 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11493 Fn->getType(),
11494 VK_LValue,
11495 Found.getDecl(),
11496 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011497 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011498 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
11499 return DRE;
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011500 } else {
11501 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
11502 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000011503 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman72899c32012-01-07 04:59:52 +000011504 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011505 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
11506 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
11507 /*isImplicit=*/true);
11508 }
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011509 } else
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011510 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011511
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +000011512 ExprValueKind valueKind;
11513 QualType type;
11514 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
11515 valueKind = VK_LValue;
11516 type = Fn->getType();
11517 } else {
11518 valueKind = VK_RValue;
11519 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
11520 }
11521
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011522 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
11523 MemExpr->isArrow(),
11524 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011525 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011526 Fn,
11527 Found,
11528 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
11529 TemplateArgs,
11530 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
11531 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Richard Smith4a030222012-11-14 07:06:31 +000011532 MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011533 return ME;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011534 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011535
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011536 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011537}
11538
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011539ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011540 DeclAccessPair Found,
11541 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011542 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor20093b42009-12-09 23:02:17 +000011543}
11544
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000011545} // end namespace clang